blob: 69f48d69a8c16b1ec9c5433ecf5bcb0bd3e0bad8 [file] [log] [blame]
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000018#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000019#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000020#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000021#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +000022#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +000029#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Douglas Gregor58e008d2008-11-13 20:12:29 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Douglas Gregor55297ac2008-12-23 00:26:44 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000032#include <algorithm>
33
34namespace clang {
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000035using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000036
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000037/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a
38/// function.
39static Expr *
40CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn,
41 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation()) {
42 Expr *E = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc);
43 S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
44 return E;
45}
46
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000047static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
48 bool InOverloadResolution,
49 StandardConversionSequence &SCS);
50static OverloadingResult
51IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
52 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
53 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
54 bool AllowExplicit);
55
56
57static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
58CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
59 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
60 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
61
62static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
63CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
64 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
65 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
66
67static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
68CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
69 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
70 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
71
72
73
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000074/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
75/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000076ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000077GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
78 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
79 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
80 ICC_Identity,
81 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
82 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
83 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +000084 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000085 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
86 ICC_Promotion,
87 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +000088 ICC_Promotion,
89 ICC_Conversion,
90 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000091 ICC_Conversion,
92 ICC_Conversion,
93 ICC_Conversion,
94 ICC_Conversion,
95 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +000096 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +000097 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +000098 ICC_Conversion,
99 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000100 ICC_Conversion
101 };
102 return Category[(int)Kind];
103}
104
105/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
106/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
107ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
108 static const ImplicitConversionRank
109 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
110 ICR_Exact_Match,
111 ICR_Exact_Match,
112 ICR_Exact_Match,
113 ICR_Exact_Match,
114 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000115 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000116 ICR_Promotion,
117 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000118 ICR_Promotion,
119 ICR_Conversion,
120 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000121 ICR_Conversion,
122 ICR_Conversion,
123 ICR_Conversion,
124 ICR_Conversion,
125 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000126 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000127 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000128 ICR_Conversion,
129 ICR_Conversion,
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +0000130 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000131 };
132 return Rank[(int)Kind];
133}
134
135/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
136/// implicit conversion.
137const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopescfca1f02009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000138 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000139 "No conversion",
140 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
141 "Array-to-pointer",
142 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000143 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000144 "Qualification",
145 "Integral promotion",
146 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000147 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000148 "Integral conversion",
149 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000150 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000151 "Floating-integral conversion",
152 "Pointer conversion",
153 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000154 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000155 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000156 "Derived-to-base conversion",
157 "Vector conversion",
158 "Vector splat",
159 "Complex-real conversion"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000160 };
161 return Name[Kind];
162}
163
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000164/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
165/// sequence to the identity conversion.
166void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
167 First = ICK_Identity;
168 Second = ICK_Identity;
169 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000170 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000171 ReferenceBinding = false;
172 DirectBinding = false;
Sebastian Redlf69a94a2009-03-29 22:46:24 +0000173 RRefBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000174 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000175}
176
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000177/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
178/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
179/// implicit conversions.
180ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
181 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
182 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
183 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
184 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
185 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
186 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
187 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
188 return Rank;
189}
190
191/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
192/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000193/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000194/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000195bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000196 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
197 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
198 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
199 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000200 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCall6d1116a2010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000201 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
202 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
203 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlsson7da7cc52010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000204 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000205 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
206 return true;
207
208 return false;
209}
210
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000211/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
212/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
213/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
214/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000215bool
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000216StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000217isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000218 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000219 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000220
221 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
222 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
223 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
224 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
225 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
226
John McCall75851b12010-10-26 06:40:27 +0000227 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000228 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000229 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
230
231 return false;
232}
233
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000234/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
235/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
236void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000237 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000238 bool PrintedSomething = false;
239 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000240 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000241 PrintedSomething = true;
242 }
243
244 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
245 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000246 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000247 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000248 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000249
250 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000251 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000252 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000253 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000254 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000255 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000256 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000257 PrintedSomething = true;
258 }
259
260 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
261 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000262 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000263 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000264 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000265 PrintedSomething = true;
266 }
267
268 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000269 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000270 }
271}
272
273/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
274/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
275void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000276 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000277 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
278 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000279 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000280 }
Benjamin Kramerb11416d2010-04-17 09:33:03 +0000281 OS << '\'' << ConversionFunction << '\'';
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000282 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000283 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000284 After.DebugPrint();
285 }
286}
287
288/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
289/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
290void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000291 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000292 switch (ConversionKind) {
293 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000294 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000295 Standard.DebugPrint();
296 break;
297 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000298 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000299 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
300 break;
301 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000302 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000303 break;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000304 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000305 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000306 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000307 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000308 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000309 break;
310 }
311
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000312 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000313}
314
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000315void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
316 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
317}
318
319void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
320 conversions().~ConversionSet();
321}
322
323void
324AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
325 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
326 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
327 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
328}
329
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000330namespace {
331 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
332 // template parameter and template argument information.
333 struct DFIParamWithArguments {
334 TemplateParameter Param;
335 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
336 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
337 };
338}
339
340/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
341/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
342OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000343static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
344 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000345 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000346 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
347 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
348 Result.Data = 0;
349 switch (TDK) {
350 case Sema::TDK_Success:
351 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000352 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
353 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000354 break;
355
356 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000357 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000358 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
359 break;
360
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000361 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000362 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000363 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
364 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000365 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
366 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
367 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
368 Result.Data = Saved;
369 break;
370 }
371
372 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000373 Result.Data = Info.take();
374 break;
375
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000376 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000377 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
378 break;
379 }
380
381 return Result;
382}
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000383
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000384void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
385 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
386 case Sema::TDK_Success:
387 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
388 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000389 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
390 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000391 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000392 break;
393
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000394 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000395 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregorb02d6b32010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000396 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000397 Data = 0;
398 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000399
400 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
401 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list?
402 Data = 0;
403 break;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000404
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000405 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000406 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000407 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
408 break;
409 }
410}
411
412TemplateParameter
413OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
414 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
415 case Sema::TDK_Success:
416 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000417 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
418 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000419 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000420 return TemplateParameter();
421
422 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000423 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000424 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
425
426 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000427 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000428 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
429
430 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000431 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000432 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
433 break;
434 }
435
436 return TemplateParameter();
437}
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000438
439TemplateArgumentList *
440OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
441 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
442 case Sema::TDK_Success:
443 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
444 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
445 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
446 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
447 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
448 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000449 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000450 return 0;
451
452 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
453 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
454
455 // Unhandled
456 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
457 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
458 break;
459 }
460
461 return 0;
462}
463
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000464const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
465 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
466 case Sema::TDK_Success:
467 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
468 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000469 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
470 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000471 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000472 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000473 return 0;
474
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000475 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000476 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000477 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
478
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000479 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000480 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000481 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
482 break;
483 }
484
485 return 0;
486}
487
488const TemplateArgument *
489OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
490 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
491 case Sema::TDK_Success:
492 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
493 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000494 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
495 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000496 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000497 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000498 return 0;
499
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000500 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000501 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000502 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
503
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000504 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000505 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000506 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
507 break;
508 }
509
510 return 0;
511}
512
513void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000514 inherited::clear();
515 Functions.clear();
516}
517
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000518// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000519// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
520// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
521// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
522// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000523// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
524// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
525// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000526//
527// Example: Given the following input:
528//
529// void f(int, float); // #1
530// void f(int, int); // #2
531// int f(int, int); // #3
532//
533// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000534// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000535//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000536// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
537// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
538// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
539// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000540//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000541// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
542// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
543// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
544// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000545// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
546// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000547//
548// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
549// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
550// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
551// into a function template's signature.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000552Sema::OverloadKind
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000553Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
554 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000555 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000556 I != E; ++I) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000557 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
558
559 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
560 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
561 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
562
563 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
564 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
565 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
566
567 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
568 }
569
570 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
571 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
572 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
573 // function templates hide function templates with different
574 // return types or template parameter lists.
575 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
576 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
577
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000578 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000579 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
580 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
581 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
582 continue;
583 }
584
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000585 Match = *I;
586 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000587 }
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000588 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000589 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
590 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
591 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
592 continue;
593 }
594
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000595 Match = *I;
596 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000597 }
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000598 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000599 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
600 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
601 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000602 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
603 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000604 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
605 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
606 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
607 // template instantiation.
608 } else {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000609 // (C++ 13p1):
610 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
611 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000612 Match = *I;
613 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000614 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000615 }
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000616
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000617 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000618}
619
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000620bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
621 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall8246e352010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000622 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
623 // overloads.
624 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC())
625 return false;
626
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000627 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
628 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
629
630 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
631 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
632 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
633 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
634 return true;
635
636 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
637 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
638 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
639
640 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
641 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
642 // in the signature, they are overloads.
643
644 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
645 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
646 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
647 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
648 return false;
649
650 FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
651 FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
652
653 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
654 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
655 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
656 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
657 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
658 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +0000659 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000660 return true;
661
662 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
663 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
664 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
665 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
666 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
667 // signature.
668 //
669 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
670 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000671 //
672 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
673 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
674 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000675 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
676 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
677 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
678 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
679 return true;
680
681 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
682 // cv-qualifiers (if any) on the function itself.
683 //
684 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
685 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
686 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
687 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
688 // can be overloaded.
689 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
690 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
691 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
692 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
693 OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers())
694 return true;
695
696 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
697 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000698}
699
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +0000700/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
701/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
702/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
703/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000704///
705/// void f(float f);
706/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
707///
708/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
709/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
710/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
711/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
712//
713/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
714/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
715/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
716/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
717/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000718///
719/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
720/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +0000721/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
722/// permitted.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000723static ImplicitConversionSequence
724TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
725 bool SuppressUserConversions,
726 bool AllowExplicit,
727 bool InOverloadResolution) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000728 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000729 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
730 ICS.Standard)) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000731 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000732 return ICS;
733 }
734
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000735 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000736 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000737 return ICS;
738 }
739
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000740 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
741 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
742 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
743 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
744 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
745 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
746 // called for those cases.
747 QualType FromType = From->getType();
748 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000749 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
750 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000751 ICS.setStandard();
752 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
753 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
754 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
755
756 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
757 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
758 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
759 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
760 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000761
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000762 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000763 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000764 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000765
766 return ICS;
767 }
768
769 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
770 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
771 // we can perform.
772 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000773 return ICS;
774 }
775
776 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000777 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
778 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000779 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000780 AllowExplicit);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000781
782 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000783 ICS.setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000784 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
785 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
786 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
787 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
788 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
789 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
790 // called for those cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000791 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000792 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000793 QualType FromCanon
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000794 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
795 QualType ToCanon
796 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +0000797 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000798 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000799 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
800 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000801 ICS.setStandard();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000802 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000803 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000804 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000805 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
Douglas Gregorbb2e68832009-02-02 22:11:10 +0000806 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000807 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
808 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000809 }
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +0000810
811 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
812 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
813 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
814 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
815 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
816 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
817 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000818 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000819 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000820 }
John McCalle8c8cd22010-01-13 22:30:33 +0000821 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000822 ICS.setAmbiguous();
823 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
824 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
825 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
826 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
827 if (Cand->Viable)
828 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000829 } else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000830 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000831 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000832
833 return ICS;
834}
835
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000836bool Sema::TryImplicitConversion(InitializationSequence &Sequence,
837 const InitializedEntity &Entity,
838 Expr *Initializer,
839 bool SuppressUserConversions,
840 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
841 bool InOverloadResolution) {
842 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
843 = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, Initializer, Entity.getType(),
844 SuppressUserConversions,
845 AllowExplicitConversions,
846 InOverloadResolution);
847 if (ICS.isBad()) return true;
848
849 // Perform the actual conversion.
850 Sequence.AddConversionSequenceStep(ICS, Entity.getType());
851 return false;
852}
853
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000854/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
855/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns true if there was an
856/// error, false otherwise. The expression From is replaced with the
857/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
858/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
859/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
860bool
861Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *&From, QualType ToType,
862 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
863 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
864 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
865}
866
867bool
868Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *&From, QualType ToType,
869 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
870 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000871 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
872 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
873 AllowExplicit,
874 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000875 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
876}
877
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000878/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
879/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
880static bool IsNoReturnConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
881 QualType ToType, QualType &ResultTy) {
882 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
883 return false;
884
885 // Strip the noreturn off the type we're converting from; noreturn can
886 // safely be removed.
887 FromType = Context.getNoReturnType(FromType, false);
888 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
889 return false;
890
891 ResultTy = FromType;
892 return true;
893}
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000894
895/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
896/// vector conversion.
897///
898/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
899/// conversion.
900static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
901 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
902 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
903 // conversion.
904 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
905 return false;
906
907 // Identical types require no conversions.
908 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
909 return false;
910
911 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
912 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
913 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
914 // identity conversion.
915 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
916 return false;
917
918 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +0000919 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000920 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
921 return true;
922 }
923 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +0000924
925 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
926 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
927 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
928 // same size
929 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
930 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
Chandler Carruth9c524c12010-08-08 05:02:51 +0000931 (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
932 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +0000933 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
934 return true;
935 }
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000936 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +0000937
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000938 return false;
939}
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000940
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000941/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
942/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
943/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
944/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
945/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
946/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
947/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
948/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000949static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
950 bool InOverloadResolution,
951 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000952 QualType FromType = From->getType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000953
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000954 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000955 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000956 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +0000957 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000958 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000959 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000960
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000961 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000962 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000963 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000964 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000965 return false;
966
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000967 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000968 }
969
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000970 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
971 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
972 // (C++ 4p1).
973
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000974 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +0000975 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
976 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000977 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
978 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +0000979 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
980 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
981 FromType = Fn->getType();
982 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
983 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
984 Type *ClassType
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000985 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
986 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +0000987 }
988 }
989
990 // If the "from" expression takes the address of the overloaded
991 // function, update the type of the resulting expression accordingly.
992 if (FromType->getAs<FunctionType>())
993 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000994 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000995 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +0000996
997 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000998 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(FromType,
999 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001000 } else {
1001 return false;
1002 }
Anders Carlssonba37e1e2010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001003 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001004 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 4.1):
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001005 // An lvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can be
1006 // converted to an rvalue.
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001007 bool argIsLValue = From->isLValue();
1008 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001009 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001010 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001011 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001012
1013 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1014 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001015 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1016 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001017 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001018 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1019 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001020 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001021
1022 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1023 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1024 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001025 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001026
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001027 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001028 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001029 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001030
1031 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1032 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1033 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1034 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001035 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1036 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001037 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001038 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001039 }
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001040 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001041 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001042 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001043
1044 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1045 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1046 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001047 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001048 } else {
1049 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001050 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001051 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001052 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001053
1054 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1055 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1056 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1057 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001058 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1059 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001060 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001061 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001062 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001063 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1064 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001065 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001066 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001067 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001068 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001069 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001070 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001071 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001072 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001073 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001074 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001075 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001076 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1077 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001078 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1079 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1080 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1081 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1082 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1083 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1084 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1085 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1086 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001087 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001088 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001089 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001090 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001091 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001092 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001093 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001094 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1095 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001096 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1097 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001098 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1099 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1100 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001101 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001102 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1103 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1104 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001105 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001106 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001107 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001108 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001109 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001110 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001111 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001112 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1113 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001114 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001115 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001116 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001117 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
1118 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001119 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001120 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001121 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001122 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1123 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001124 } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1125 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001126 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001127 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001128 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001129 } else if (IsNoReturnConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001130 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1131 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001132 } else {
1133 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001134 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001135 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001136 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001137
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001138 QualType CanonFrom;
1139 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001140 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001141 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001142 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001143 FromType = ToType;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001144 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1145 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001146 } else {
1147 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001148 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1149
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001150 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001151 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1152 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1153 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001154 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1155 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001156 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
1157 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian9f963c22010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001158 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
1159 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr())) {
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001160 FromType = ToType;
1161 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1162 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001163 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001164 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001165
1166 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1167 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001168 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001169 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001170
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001171 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001172}
1173
1174/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1175/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1176/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1177/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001178bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001179 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlee547972008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001180 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001181 if (!To) {
1182 return false;
1183 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001184
1185 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1186 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1187 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1188 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1189 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregora71cc152010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001190 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1191 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001192 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1193 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1194 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1195 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001196 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001197 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001198 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001199 }
1200
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001201 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1202 }
1203
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001204 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3:
1205 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1206 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1207 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1208 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1209 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
1210 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
1211 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
1212 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
1213 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1214 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
1215 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001216 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1217 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1218 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1219 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1220 return false;
1221
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001222 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
Douglas Gregorc87f4d42010-09-12 03:38:25 +00001223 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
1224 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag()))
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001225 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1226 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001227 }
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001228
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001229 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
1230 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1231 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1232 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
1233 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
1234 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
1235 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
1236 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
1237 // type.
1238 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
1239 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001240 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1241 // unsigned.
1242 bool FromIsSigned;
1243 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001244
1245 // FIXME: Is wchar_t signed or unsigned? We assume it's signed for now.
1246 FromIsSigned = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001247
1248 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1249 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001250 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1251 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001252 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1253 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001254 };
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001255 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001256 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1257 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001258 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001259 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1260 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1261 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1262 // promotion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001263 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001264 }
1265 }
1266 }
1267
1268 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1269 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1270 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1271 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1272 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1273 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1274 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001275 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1276 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001277 using llvm::APSInt;
1278 if (From)
1279 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001280 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001281 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001282 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1283 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1284 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001285
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001286 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1287 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1288 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1289 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1290 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001291
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001292 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1293 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1294 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1295 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1296 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001297
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001298 return false;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001299 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001300 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001301
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001302 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1303 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001304 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001305 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001306 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001307
1308 return false;
1309}
1310
1311/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1312/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1313/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001314bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001315 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1316 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001317 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1318 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001319 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1320 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1321 return true;
1322
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001323 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1324 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1325 // double is promoted to long double [...].
1326 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1327 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1328 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1329 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1330 return true;
1331 }
1332
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001333 return false;
1334}
1335
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001336/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1337///
1338/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1339/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001340/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001341bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001342 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001343 if (!FromComplex)
1344 return false;
1345
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001346 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001347 if (!ToComplex)
1348 return false;
1349
1350 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001351 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1352 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1353 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001354}
1355
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001356/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1357/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1358/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1359/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1360/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001361static QualType
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001362BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001363 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
1364 ASTContext &Context) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001365 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1366 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1367 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
Douglas Gregorc6bd1d32010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001368
1369 /// \brief Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1370 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
1371 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1372
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001373 QualType CanonFromPointee
1374 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001375 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001376 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001377
1378 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001379 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001380 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001381 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregorb9f907b2010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001382 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001383
1384 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1385 // already.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001386 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1387 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001388 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1389 }
1390
1391 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001392 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1393 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001394
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001395 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1396 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1397 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001398}
1399
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001400static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001401 bool InOverloadResolution,
1402 ASTContext &Context) {
1403 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1404 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1405 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001406 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001407 return !InOverloadResolution;
1408
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001409 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1410 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1411 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001412}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001413
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001414/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1415/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1416/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1417/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1418/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1419/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001420///
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001421/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1422/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1423/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1424/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1425/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1426/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001427/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1428/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1429/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001430bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001431 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001432 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001433 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001434 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001435 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1436 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001437 return true;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001438
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001439 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1440 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001441 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor79a6b012008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001442 ConvertedType = ToType;
1443 return true;
1444 }
1445
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001446 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1447 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001448 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001449 ConvertedType = ToType;
1450 return true;
1451 }
1452 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1453 // pointer type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001454 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001455 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001456 ConvertedType = ToType;
1457 return true;
1458 }
1459
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001460 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1461 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001462 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001463 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001464 ConvertedType = ToType;
1465 return true;
1466 }
1467
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001468 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001469 if (!ToTypePtr)
1470 return false;
1471
1472 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001473 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001474 ConvertedType = ToType;
1475 return true;
1476 }
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001477
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001478 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
1479 // , including objective-c pointers.
1480 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
1481 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001482 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
1483 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
1484 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001485 ToType, Context);
1486 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001487 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001488 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001489 if (!FromTypePtr)
1490 return false;
1491
1492 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001493
Douglas Gregorfb640862010-08-18 21:25:30 +00001494 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
1495 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
1496 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
1497 return false;
1498
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001499 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1500 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
1501 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedmana170cd62010-08-05 02:49:48 +00001502 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
1503 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001504 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001505 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001506 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001507 return true;
1508 }
1509
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001510 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
1511 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001512 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001513 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001514 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001515 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001516 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001517 return true;
1518 }
1519
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001520 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001521 //
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001522 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
1523 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
1524 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
1525 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
1526 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
1527 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
1528 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
1529 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
1530 //
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001531 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
1532 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001533 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1534 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregord28f0412010-02-22 17:06:41 +00001535 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregore6fb91f2009-10-29 23:08:22 +00001536 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001537 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001538 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001539 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001540 ToType, Context);
1541 return true;
1542 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001543
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001544 return false;
1545}
1546
1547/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
1548/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
1549/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001550bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001551 QualType& ConvertedType,
1552 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
1553 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1554 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001555
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001556 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001557 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
1558 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001559 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001560 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001561
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001562 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001563 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
1564 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
1565 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1566 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1567 return false;
1568
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001569 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001570 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001571 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001572 ConvertedType = ToType;
1573 return true;
1574 }
1575 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001576 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001577 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001578 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00001579 /*compare=*/false)) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001580 ConvertedType = ToType;
1581 return true;
1582 }
1583 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
1584 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
1585 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00001586 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1587 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1588 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
1589 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
1590 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1591 return false;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001592 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
1593 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1594 ToType, Context);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001595 return true;
1596 }
1597
1598 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
1599 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
1600 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
1601 // complain about it.
1602 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001603 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
1604 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1605 ToType, Context);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001606 return true;
1607 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001608 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001609 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001610 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001611 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001612 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001613 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
1614 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001615 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001616 // to a block pointer type.
1617 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
1618 ConvertedType = ToType;
1619 return true;
1620 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001621 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001622 }
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001623 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
1624 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
1625 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001626 // pointer to any object.
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001627 ConvertedType = ToType;
1628 return true;
1629 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001630 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001631 return false;
1632
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001633 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001634 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001635 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001636 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
1637 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001638 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1639 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001640 return false;
1641
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001642 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
1643 // is an Objective-C conversion.
1644 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
1645 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1646 IncompatibleObjC)) {
1647 // We always complain about this conversion.
1648 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001649 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001650 return true;
1651 }
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001652 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
1653 // as in I* to id.
1654 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1655 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1656 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1657 IncompatibleObjC)) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001658 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001659 return true;
1660 }
1661
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001662 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001663 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1664 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
1665 // complain about it).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001666 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001667 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001668 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001669 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001670 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
1671 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
1672 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
1673 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
1674 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
1675 return false;
1676
1677 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1678 // function types are obviously different.
1679 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1680 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
1681 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
1682 return false;
1683
1684 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
1685 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
1686 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
1687 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1688 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1689 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
1690 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1691 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1692 HasObjCConversion = true;
1693 } else {
1694 // Function types are too different. Abort.
1695 return false;
1696 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001697
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001698 // Check argument types.
1699 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1700 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1701 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1702 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1703 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
1704 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
1705 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1706 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
1707 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1708 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1709 HasObjCConversion = true;
1710 } else {
1711 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1712 return false;
1713 }
1714 }
1715
1716 if (HasObjCConversion) {
1717 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
1718 // conversion, but complain about it.
1719 ConvertedType = ToType;
1720 IncompatibleObjC = true;
1721 return true;
1722 }
1723 }
1724
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001725 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001726}
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001727
1728/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
1729/// for equlity of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
1730/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
1731/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
1732bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FunctionProtoType* OldType,
1733 FunctionProtoType* NewType){
1734 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1735 return std::equal(OldType->arg_type_begin(), OldType->arg_type_end(),
1736 NewType->arg_type_begin());
1737
1738 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
1739 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
1740 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
1741 QualType ToType = (*O);
1742 QualType FromType = (*N);
1743 if (ToType != FromType) {
1744 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1745 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth27c9fe92010-05-06 00:15:06 +00001746 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
1747 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
1748 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
1749 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001750 continue;
1751 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001752 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
1753 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
1754 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
1755 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
1756 if (PTTo->getInterfaceDecl() == PTFr->getInterfaceDecl())
1757 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001758 }
1759 return false;
1760 }
1761 }
1762 return true;
1763}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001764
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001765/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
1766/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00001767/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001768/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
1769/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
1770/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00001771bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001772 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001773 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00001774 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001775 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00001776 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001777
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001778 Kind = CK_BitCast;
1779
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00001780 if (CXXBoolLiteralExpr* LitBool
1781 = dyn_cast<CXXBoolLiteralExpr>(From->IgnoreParens()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00001782 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && LitBool->getValue() == false)
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00001783 Diag(LitBool->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_init_pointer_from_false)
1784 << ToType;
1785
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001786 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
1787 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001788 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
1789 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor1e57a3f2008-12-18 23:43:31 +00001790
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001791 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
1792 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001793 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
1794 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00001795 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
1796 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00001797 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00001798 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00001799 return true;
1800
1801 // The conversion was successful.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001802 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001803 }
1804 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001805 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001806 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001807 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001808 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001809 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
1810 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
1811 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001812 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001813 return false;
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001814 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001815 }
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001816
1817 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
1818 // reasons.
1819 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1820 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
1821
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001822 return false;
1823}
1824
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001825/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1826/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
1827/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
1828/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
1829/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
1830bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001831 QualType ToType,
1832 bool InOverloadResolution,
1833 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001834 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001835 if (!ToTypePtr)
1836 return false;
1837
1838 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001839 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1840 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1841 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001842 ConvertedType = ToType;
1843 return true;
1844 }
1845
1846 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001847 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001848 if (!FromTypePtr)
1849 return false;
1850
1851 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
1852 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
1853 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
1854 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
1855 // FIXME: What happens when these are dependent? Is this function even called?
1856
1857 if (IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
1858 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
1859 ToClass.getTypePtr());
1860 return true;
1861 }
1862
1863 return false;
1864}
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001865
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001866/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
1867/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00001868/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001869/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
1870/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
1871/// otherwise.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001872bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001873 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001874 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00001875 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001876 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001877 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00001878 if (!FromPtrType) {
1879 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001880 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1881 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00001882 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001883 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001884 return false;
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00001885 }
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001886
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001887 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001888 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
1889 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001890
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001891 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
1892 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001893
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001894 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
1895 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
1896 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001897
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00001898 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +00001899 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001900 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
1901 assert(DerivationOkay &&
1902 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
1903 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001904
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001905 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
1906 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001907 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
1908 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
1909 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
1910 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001911 }
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001912
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00001913 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001914 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
1915 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
1916 << From->getSourceRange();
1917 return true;
1918 }
1919
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00001920 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall1064d7e2010-03-16 05:22:47 +00001921 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
1922 Paths.front(),
1923 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00001924
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00001925 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00001926 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001927 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001928 return false;
1929}
1930
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001931/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
1932/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
1933/// (C++ 4.4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001934bool
1935Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001936 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1937 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1938
1939 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
1940 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redlcbdffb12010-02-03 19:36:07 +00001941 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001942 return false;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001943
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001944 // (C++ 4.4p4):
1945 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
1946 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
1947 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001948 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00001949 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001950 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
1951 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
1952 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00001953 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001954 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
1955 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00001956 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001957
1958 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
1959 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregorea2d4212008-10-22 00:38:21 +00001960 if (!ToType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromType))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001961 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001962
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001963 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
1964 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
1965 if (FromType.getCVRQualifiers() != ToType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00001966 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001967 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001968
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001969 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
1970 // include const.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001971 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001972 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToType.isConstQualified();
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00001973 }
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001974
1975 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
1976 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
1977 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
1978 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
1979 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001980 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001981}
1982
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00001983/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
1984/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
1985/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
1986/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
1987/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
1988/// false and User is unspecified.
1989///
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00001990/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
1991/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
1992/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001993static OverloadingResult
1994IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1995 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
1996 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
1997 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001998 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
1999 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
2000
2001 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
2002 // constructors.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002003 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002004 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
2005 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
2006 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
2007 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
2008 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
2009 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
2010 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
2011 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002012 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002013 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002014 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002015 ConstructorsOnly = true;
2016
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002017 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag())) {
Douglas Gregor3ec1bf22009-11-05 13:06:35 +00002018 // We're not going to find any constructors.
2019 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
2020 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002021 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002022 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002023 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002024 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2025 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2026
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002027 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2028 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2029 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002030 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002031 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002032 Constructor
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002033 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2034 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002035 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00002036
Fariborz Jahanian11a8e952009-08-06 17:22:51 +00002037 if (!Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
Anders Carlssond20e7952009-08-28 16:57:08 +00002038 Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit)) {
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002039 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002040 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2041 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
2042 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2043 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2044 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002045 else
Fariborz Jahanianb3c44f92009-10-01 20:39:51 +00002046 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
2047 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002048 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
2049 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2050 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2051 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002052 }
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002053 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002054 }
2055 }
2056
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002057 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
2058 if (ConstructorsOnly) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002059 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(),
2060 S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00002061 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002062 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002063 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002064 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002065 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
2066 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002067 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianf4061e32009-09-14 20:41:01 +00002068 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002069 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002070 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002071 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
2072 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00002073 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2074 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2075 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2076
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002077 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2078 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002079 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
2080 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002081 else
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002082 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002083
2084 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
2085 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002086 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
2087 ActingContext, From, ToType,
2088 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002089 else
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002090 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
2091 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002092 }
2093 }
2094 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002095 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002096
2097 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00002098 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002099 case OR_Success:
2100 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2101 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
2102 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
2103 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2104 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2105 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
2106 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
2107 // the argument of the constructor.
2108 //
2109 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2110 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
2111 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
2112 else {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002113 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00002114 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002115 }
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002116 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2117 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2118 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2119 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2120 return OR_Success;
2121 } else if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
2122 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
2123 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2124 //
2125 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2126 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
2127 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
2128 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
2129 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2130 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
2131 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002132
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002133 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
2134 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
2135 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
2136 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
2137 // is an initialization, the special rules for
2138 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
2139 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
2140 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
2141 // 13.3.3.1).
2142 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
2143 return OR_Success;
2144 } else {
2145 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002146 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002147 }
2148
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002149 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2150 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2151 case OR_Deleted:
2152 // No conversion here! We're done.
2153 return OR_Deleted;
2154
2155 case OR_Ambiguous:
2156 return OR_Ambiguous;
2157 }
2158
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002159 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002160}
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002161
2162bool
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002163Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002164 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00002165 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002166 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002167 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002168 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002169 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
2170 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2171 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
2172 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2173 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
2174 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2175 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
2176 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2177 else
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002178 return false;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002179 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &From, 1);
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002180 return true;
2181}
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002182
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002183/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
2184/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2185/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002186static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2187CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2188 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
2189 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002190{
2191 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
2192 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
2193 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
2194 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
2195 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
2196 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
2197 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
2198 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002199 //
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002200 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
2201 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
2202 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
2203 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
2204 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002205 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
2206 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2207 else if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
2208 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002209
Benjamin Kramer98ff7f82010-04-18 12:05:54 +00002210 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
2211 // the same kind.
2212 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
2213 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2214
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002215 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
2216 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
2217 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002218 if (ICS1.isStandard())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002219 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002220 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002221 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
2222 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
2223 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
2224 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
2225 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
2226 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002227 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002228 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002229 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
2230 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002231 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
2232 }
2233
2234 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2235}
2236
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002237static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
2238 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
2239 Qualifiers Quals;
2240 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
2241 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
2242 }
2243
2244 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
2245}
2246
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002247// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
2248// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
2249static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2250compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
2251 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2252 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
2253 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
2254 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2255
Douglas Gregore87561a2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00002256 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
2257 // any non-identity conversion sequence
2258 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding == SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
2259 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2260 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2261 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2262 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2263 }
2264
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002265 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
2266 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
2267 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2268 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
2269 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2270 else
2271 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002272 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002273 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2274
2275 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
2276 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
2277 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2278 }
2279
2280 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
2281 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2282 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2283 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2284
2285 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
2286 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2287 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2288 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2289
2290 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2291}
2292
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002293/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
2294/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2295/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002296static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2297CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2298 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2299 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002300{
2301 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
2302 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
2303
2304 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
2305 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
2306 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
2307 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
2308 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002309 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002310 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002311 return CK;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002312
2313 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
2314 // defined below), or, if not that,
2315 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
2316 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
2317 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
2318 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2319 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
2320 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002321
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002322 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
2323 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
2324 // applies:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002325
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002326 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
2327 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
2328 // that is such a conversion.
2329 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
2330 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
2331 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2332 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2333
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002334 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
2335 //
2336 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002337 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
2338 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
2339 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002340 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002341 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002342 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002343 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002344 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2345 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
2346 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002347 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2348 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002349 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2350 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
2351 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002352 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002353 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002354 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002355 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2356 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
2357 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
2358 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002359 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
2360 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002361
2362 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2363 // conversion, if we need to.
2364 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002365 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002366 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002367 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002368
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002369 QualType FromPointee1
2370 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
2371 QualType FromPointee2
2372 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002373
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002374 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002375 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002376 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002377 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2378
2379 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
2380 // other, it is the better one.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002381 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface1 = FromPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2382 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface2 = FromPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002383 if (FromIface1 && FromIface1) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002384 if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface2, FromIface1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002385 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002386 else if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface1, FromIface2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002387 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2388 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002389 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002390
2391 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
2392 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002393 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002394 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002395 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002396
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002397 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00002398 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2399 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
2400 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
2401 // without a ref-qualifier, and S1 binds an rvalue reference to an
2402 // rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference.
Sebastian Redl4c0cd852009-03-29 15:27:50 +00002403 // FIXME: We don't know if we're dealing with the implicit object parameter,
2404 // or if the member function in this case has a ref qualifier.
2405 // (Of course, we don't have ref qualifiers yet.)
2406 if (SCS1.RRefBinding != SCS2.RRefBinding)
2407 return SCS1.RRefBinding ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2408 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00002409
2410 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2411 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
2412 // which the references refer are the same type except for
2413 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
2414 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
2415 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002416 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2417 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002418 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2419 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002420 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002421 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2422 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002423 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002424 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
2425 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002426 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002427 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002428 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002429 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002430 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
2431 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2432 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
2433 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2434 }
2435 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002436
2437 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2438}
2439
2440/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2441/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002442/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
2443ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002444CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
2445 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2446 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregor4b62ec62008-10-22 15:04:37 +00002447 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002448 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
2449 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
2450 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
2451 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
2452 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
2453 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
2454 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
2455 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2456
2457 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
2458 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002459 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2460 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002461 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2462 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002463 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002464 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2465 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002466
2467 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
2468 // them.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002469 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002470 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2471
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002472 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
2473 // for comparison.
2474 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002475 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002476 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002477 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002478
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002479 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002480 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002481 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002482 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2483 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2484 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002485 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002486 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
2487 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
2488 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
2489 // strict subset of qualifiers.
2490 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
2491 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
2492 // about how the sequences rank.
2493 ;
2494 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
2495 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2496 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
2497 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2498 // qualifiers.
2499 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002500
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002501 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2502 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
2503 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2504 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
2505 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2506 // qualifiers.
2507 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002508
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002509 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2510 } else {
2511 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
2512 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2513 }
2514
2515 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002516 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002517 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002518 }
2519
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002520 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
2521 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
2522 switch (Result) {
2523 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002524 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002525 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2526 break;
2527
2528 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
2529 break;
2530
2531 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002532 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002533 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2534 break;
2535 }
2536
2537 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002538}
2539
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002540/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2541/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002542/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
2543/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
2544/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002545ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002546CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
2547 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2548 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002549 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002550 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002551 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002552 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002553
2554 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2555 // conversion, if we need to.
2556 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002557 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002558 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002559 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002560
2561 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002562 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
2563 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
2564 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
2565 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002566
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002567 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002568 //
2569 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
2570 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002571 //
2572 // For Objective-C, we let A, B, and C also be Objective-C
2573 // interfaces.
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002574
2575 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002576 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00002577 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
2578 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
2579 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
2580 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002581 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002582 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002583 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002584 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002585 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002586 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002587 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002588 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002589
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002590 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface1 = FromPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2591 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface2 = FromPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2592 const ObjCObjectType* ToIface1 = ToPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2593 const ObjCObjectType* ToIface2 = ToPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002594
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002595 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002596 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002597 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002598 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002599 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002600 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002601
2602 if (ToIface1 && ToIface2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002603 if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToIface2, ToIface1))
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002604 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002605 else if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToIface1, ToIface2))
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002606 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2607 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002608 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002609
2610 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
2611 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002612 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002613 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002614 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002615 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002616
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002617 if (FromIface1 && FromIface2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002618 if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface1, FromIface2))
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002619 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002620 else if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface2, FromIface1))
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002621 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2622 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002623 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002624 }
2625
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002626 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002627 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
2628 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
2629 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
2630 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
2631 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2632 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
2633 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2634 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
2635 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2636 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
2637 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2638 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
2639 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
2640 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
2641 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
2642 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2643 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2644 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2645 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002646 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002647 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002648 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002649 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002650 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002651 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2652 }
2653 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
2654 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002655 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002656 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002657 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002658 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2659 }
2660 }
2661
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002662 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002663 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00002664 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
2665 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
2666 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002667 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2668 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
2669 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002670 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002671 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002672 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2673 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002674
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002675 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00002676 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
2677 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
2678 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002679 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2680 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
2681 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002682 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002683 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002684 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2685 }
2686 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002687
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002688 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2689}
2690
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002691/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
2692/// determine whether they are reference-related,
2693/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
2694/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
2695/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
2696/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
2697/// type being initialized.
2698Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
2699Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
2700 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002701 bool &DerivedToBase,
2702 bool &ObjCConversion) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002703 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
2704 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
2705 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
2706
2707 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
2708 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
2709 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
2710 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2711 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
2712
2713 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
2714 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
2715 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
2716 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002717 DerivedToBase = false;
2718 ObjCConversion = false;
2719 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
2720 // Nothing to do.
2721 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002722 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
2723 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002724 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
2725 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
2726 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
2727 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002728 else
2729 return Ref_Incompatible;
2730
2731 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
2732 // least).
2733
2734 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
2735 // for comparison.
2736 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
2737 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
2738 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
2739 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
2740
2741 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
2742 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
2743 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
2744 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
2745 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
2746 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
2747 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
2748 if (T1Quals.getCVRQualifiers() == T2Quals.getCVRQualifiers())
2749 return Ref_Compatible;
2750 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
2751 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
2752 else
2753 return Ref_Related;
2754}
2755
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002756/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002757/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
2758static bool
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002759FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
2760 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
2761 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
2762 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002763 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
2764 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
2765 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
2766
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002767 QualType ToType
2768 = AllowRvalues? DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType()
2769 : DeclType;
2770
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002771 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
2772 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
2773 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
2774 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
2775 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
2776 NamedDecl *D = *I;
2777 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2778 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2779 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2780
2781 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
2782 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2783 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2784 if (ConvTemplate)
2785 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
2786 else
2787 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
2788
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002789 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
2790 // explicit conversions, skip it.
2791 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
2792 continue;
2793
2794 if (AllowRvalues) {
2795 bool DerivedToBase = false;
2796 bool ObjCConversion = false;
2797 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002798 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
2799 DeclLoc,
2800 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
2801 .getUnqualifiedType(),
2802 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
2803 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion) ==
2804 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002805 continue;
2806 } else {
2807 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
2808 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
2809 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
2810
2811 const ReferenceType *RefType =
2812 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2813 if (!RefType ||
2814 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
2815 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
2816 continue;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002817 }
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002818
2819 if (ConvTemplate)
2820 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
2821 Init, ToType, CandidateSet);
2822 else
2823 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
2824 ToType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002825 }
2826
2827 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00002828 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002829 case OR_Success:
2830 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
2831 //
2832 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
2833 // applying a conversion function to the argument
2834 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
2835 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
2836 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
2837 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
2838 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
2839 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
2840 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
2841 return false;
2842
2843 ICS.setUserDefined();
2844 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2845 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
2846 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
2847 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
2848 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
2849 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
2850 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
2851 return true;
2852
2853 case OR_Ambiguous:
2854 ICS.setAmbiguous();
2855 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
2856 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
2857 if (Cand->Viable)
2858 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
2859 return true;
2860
2861 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2862 case OR_Deleted:
2863 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
2864 // conversion; continue with other checks.
2865 return false;
2866 }
Eric Christopheraba9fb22010-06-30 18:36:32 +00002867
2868 return false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002869}
2870
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002871/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
2872/// initialization.
2873static ImplicitConversionSequence
2874TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *&Init, QualType DeclType,
2875 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
2876 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00002877 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002878 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
2879
2880 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
2881 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
2882 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
2883
2884 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
2885 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
2886
2887 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
2888 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
2889 // type of the resulting function.
2890 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
2891 DeclAccessPair Found;
2892 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
2893 false, Found))
2894 T2 = Fn->getType();
2895 }
2896
2897 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
2898 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
2899 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002900 bool ObjCConversion = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002901 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002902 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002903 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
2904 ObjCConversion);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002905
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002906
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002907 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00002908 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
2909 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
2910
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002911 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
2912 // The next bullet point (T1 is a function) is pretty much equivalent to this
2913 // one, so it's handled here.
2914 if (!isRValRef || T1->isFunctionType()) {
2915 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
2916 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
2917 //
2918 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
2919 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
2920 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002921 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002922 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
2923 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
2924 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
2925 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
2926 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
2927 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
2928 ICS.setStandard();
2929 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002930 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
2931 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
2932 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002933 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
2934 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
2935 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
2936 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
2937 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
2938 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
2939 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
2940 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = isRValRef;
2941 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002942
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002943 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
2944 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
2945 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
2946 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002947 return ICS;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002948 }
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002949
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002950 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
2951 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
2952 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
2953 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
2954 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
2955 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
2956 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
2957 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
2958 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
2959 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00002960 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
2961 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
2962 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002963 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002964 }
2965 }
2966
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002967 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
2968 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
2969 // shall be an rvalue reference and the initializer expression shall be
2970 // an rvalue or have a function type.
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00002971 //
2972 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
2973 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
2974 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
2975 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
2976 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
2977 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
2978 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002979 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
2980 // go together.
2981 if ((!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified()) ||
2982 (isRValRef && InitCategory.isLValue()))
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002983 return ICS;
2984
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002985 // -- If T1 is a function type, then
2986 // -- if T2 is the same type as T1, the reference is bound to the
2987 // initializer expression lvalue;
2988 // -- if T2 is a class type and the initializer expression can be
2989 // implicitly converted to an lvalue of type T1 [...], the
2990 // reference is bound to the function lvalue that is the result
2991 // of the conversion;
2992 // This is the same as for the lvalue case above, so it was handled there.
2993 // -- otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
2994 // This is the one difference to the lvalue case.
2995 if (T1->isFunctionType())
2996 return ICS;
2997
2998 // -- Otherwise, if T2 is a class type and
Douglas Gregorf93df192010-04-18 08:46:23 +00002999 // -- the initializer expression is an rvalue and "cv1 T1"
3000 // is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003001 //
Douglas Gregorf93df192010-04-18 08:46:23 +00003002 // -- T1 is not reference-related to T2 and the initializer
3003 // expression can be implicitly converted to an rvalue
3004 // of type "cv3 T3" (this conversion is selected by
3005 // enumerating the applicable conversion functions
3006 // (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best one through overload
3007 // resolution (13.3)),
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003008 //
Douglas Gregorf93df192010-04-18 08:46:23 +00003009 // then the reference is bound to the initializer
3010 // expression rvalue in the first case and to the object
3011 // that is the result of the conversion in the second case
3012 // (or, in either case, to the appropriate base class
3013 // subobject of the object).
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003014 if (T2->isRecordType()) {
3015 // First case: "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2". This is a
3016 // direct binding in C++0x but not in C++03.
3017 if (InitCategory.isRValue() &&
3018 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
3019 ICS.setStandard();
3020 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
3021 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
3022 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3023 : ICK_Identity;
3024 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3025 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3026 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3027 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3028 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3029 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3030 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x;
3031 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = isRValRef;
3032 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
3033 return ICS;
3034 }
3035
3036 // Second case: not reference-related.
3037 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
3038 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
3039 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3040 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
3041 AllowExplicit))
3042 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003043 }
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003044
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003045 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
3046 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
3047 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
3048 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
3049 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
3050 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
3051 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
3052 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
3053 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
3054 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
3055 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
3056 // initialization fails.
3057 return ICS;
3058 }
3059
3060 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
3061 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
3062 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
3063 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
3064 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
3065 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
3066 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
3067 return ICS;
3068
3069 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003070 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
3071 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
3072 // required to convert the argument expression to the
3073 // underlying type of the reference according to
3074 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
3075 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
3076 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
3077 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
3078 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003079 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
3080 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
3081 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003082
3083 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
3084 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
3085 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3086 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = isRValRef;
3087 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
3088 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
3089 ICS.UserDefined.After.RRefBinding = isRValRef;
3090 }
3091 return ICS;
3092}
3093
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003094/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
3095/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
3096/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
3097/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003098/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00003099/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003100static ImplicitConversionSequence
3101TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregordcd27ff2010-04-16 17:53:55 +00003102 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003103 bool InOverloadResolution) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003104 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003105 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003106 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
3107 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003108 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003109
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003110 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
3111 SuppressUserConversions,
3112 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
3113 InOverloadResolution);
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003114}
3115
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003116/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
3117/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
3118/// expression @p From.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003119static ImplicitConversionSequence
3120TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType,
3121 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
3122 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
3123 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00003124 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
3125 // const volatile object.
3126 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
3127 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003128 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003129
3130 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
3131 // to exit early.
3132 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003133
3134 // We need to have an object of class type.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00003135 QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003136 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003137 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
3138
3139 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003140
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00003141 // The implicit object parameter is has the type "reference to cv X",
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003142 // where X is the class of which the function is a member
3143 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p4). However, when finding an implicit
3144 // conversion sequence for the argument, we are not allowed to
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003145 // create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003146 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
3147 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
3148 // non-constant references.
3149
3150 // First check the qualifiers. We don't care about lvalue-vs-rvalue
3151 // with the implicit object parameter (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003152 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003153 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
3154 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003155 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003156 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
3157 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003158 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003159 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003160
3161 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
3162 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003163 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003164 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
3165 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
3166 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003167 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003168 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003169 else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003170 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
3171 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003172 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003173 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003174
3175 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003176 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003177 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
3178 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003179 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003180 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003181 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3182 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Sebastian Redlf69a94a2009-03-29 22:46:24 +00003183 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003184 return ICS;
3185}
3186
3187/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
3188/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
3189/// expression.
3190bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003191Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *&From,
3192 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003193 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003194 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003195 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003196 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003197 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003198
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003199 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003200 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
3201 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
3202 } else {
3203 FromRecordType = From->getType();
3204 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
3205 }
3206
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003207 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
3208 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003209 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003210 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), Method,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003211 Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003212 if (ICS.isBad()) {
3213 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
3214 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
3215 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
3216 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
3217 if (CVR) {
3218 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3219 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
3220 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
3221 << From->getSourceRange();
3222 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
3223 << Method->getDeclName();
3224 return true;
3225 }
3226 }
3227
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003228 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003229 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003230 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003231 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003232
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003233 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003234 return PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003235
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003236 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003237 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00003238 From->getType()->isPointerType() ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003239 return false;
3240}
3241
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003242/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
3243/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003244static ImplicitConversionSequence
3245TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregor0bbe94d2010-05-08 22:41:50 +00003246 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003247 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonef4c7212009-08-27 17:24:15 +00003248 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3249 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003250 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00003251 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003252}
3253
3254/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
3255/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
3256bool Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *&From) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003257 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003258 if (!ICS.isBad())
3259 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003260
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003261 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003262 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3263 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
3264 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
3265 return true;
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003266}
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003267
3268/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Attempt to contextually convert the
3269/// expression From to 'id'.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003270static ImplicitConversionSequence
3271TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
3272 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
3273 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
3274 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3275 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
3276 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
3277 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003278}
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003279
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003280/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Perform a contextual conversion
3281/// of the expression From to 'id'.
3282bool Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Expr *&From) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003283 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003284 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003285 if (!ICS.isBad())
3286 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
3287 return true;
3288}
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003289
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003290/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
3291/// enumeration type.
3292///
3293/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
3294/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
3295/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3296///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003297/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
3298/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003299///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003300/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from.
3301///
3302/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not
3303/// have integral or enumeration type.
3304///
3305/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has
3306/// incomplete class type.
3307///
3308/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an
3309/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions
3310/// were available). This is a recovery mode.
3311///
3312/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag,
3313/// showing which conversion was picked.
3314///
3315/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one
3316/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type.
3317///
3318/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each
3319/// usable conversion function.
3320///
3321/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion
3322/// function, which may be an extension in this case.
3323///
3324/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
3325/// successful.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003326ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003327Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003328 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
3329 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
3330 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag,
3331 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote,
3332 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003333 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
3334 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003335 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
3336 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003337 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003338
3339 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
3340 QualType T = From->getType();
3341 if (T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003342 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003343
3344 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
3345
3346 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
3347 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
3348 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
3349 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
3350 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3351 << T << From->getSourceRange();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003352 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003353 }
3354
3355 // We must have a complete class type.
3356 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003357 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003358
3359 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3360 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
3361 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
3362 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3363 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3364
3365 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3366 E = Conversions->end();
3367 I != E;
3368 ++I) {
3369 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3370 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
3371 if (Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3372 ->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
3373 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
3374 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3375 else
3376 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3377 }
3378 }
3379
3380 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
3381 case 0:
3382 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1) {
3383 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
3384 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3385 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
3386
3387 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
3388 // conversion; use it.
3389 QualType ConvTy
3390 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3391 std::string TypeStr;
3392 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, Context.PrintingPolicy);
3393
3394 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag)
3395 << T << ConvTy
3396 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
3397 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
3398 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
3399 ")");
3400 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote)
3401 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
3402
3403 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
3404 // explicit conversion function.
3405 if (isSFINAEContext())
3406 return ExprError();
3407
3408 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003409 From = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003410 }
3411
3412 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
3413 break;
3414
3415 case 1: {
3416 // Apply this conversion.
3417 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
3418 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003419
3420 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3421 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
3422 QualType ConvTy
3423 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3424 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
3425 if (isSFINAEContext())
3426 return ExprError();
3427
3428 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag)
3429 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange();
3430 }
3431
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003432 From = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003433 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003434 break;
3435 }
3436
3437 default:
3438 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag)
3439 << T << From->getSourceRange();
3440 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
3441 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
3442 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
3443 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3444 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote)
3445 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
3446 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003447 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003448 }
3449
Douglas Gregor5823da32010-06-29 23:25:20 +00003450 if (!From->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003451 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3452 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003453
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003454 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003455}
3456
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003457/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003458/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
3459/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
3460/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003461///
3462/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
3463/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
3464/// code completion.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003465void
3466Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003467 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003468 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003469 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl42e92c42009-04-12 17:16:29 +00003470 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003471 bool PartialOverloading) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003472 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003473 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003474 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003475 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003476 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003477
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003478 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003479 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
3480 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
3481 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
3482 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
3483 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003484 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
3485 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
3486 // is irrelevant.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003487 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003488 QualType(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003489 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003490 return;
3491 }
3492 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
3493 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003494 }
3495
Douglas Gregorff7028a2009-11-13 23:59:09 +00003496 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003497 return;
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003498
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003499 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00003500 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003501
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003502 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
3503 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
3504 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
3505 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
3506 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
3507 if (NumArgs == 1 &&
Douglas Gregorbd6b17f2010-11-08 17:16:59 +00003508 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor901e7172010-02-21 18:30:38 +00003509 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
3510 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003511 return;
3512 }
3513
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003514 // Add this candidate
3515 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3516 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003517 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003518 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003519 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003520 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003521 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003522
3523 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3524
3525 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
3526 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
3527 // list (8.3.5).
Douglas Gregor2a920012009-09-23 14:56:09 +00003528 if ((NumArgs + (PartialOverloading && NumArgs)) > NumArgsInProto &&
3529 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003530 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003531 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003532 return;
3533 }
3534
3535 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
3536 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
3537 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
3538 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
3539 // exactly m parameters.
3540 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003541 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003542 // Not enough arguments.
3543 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003544 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003545 return;
3546 }
3547
3548 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
3549 // arguments.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003550 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
3551 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
3552 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
3553 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
3554 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
3555 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
3556 // parameter of F.
3557 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003558 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003559 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00003560 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00003561 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003562 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
3563 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003564 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003565 break;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003566 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003567 } else {
3568 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
3569 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
3570 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003571 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003572 }
3573 }
3574}
3575
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003576/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
3577/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003578void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003579 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3580 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
3581 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003582 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003583 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
3584 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003585 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003586 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003587 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
3588 Args[0]->getType(), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003589 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3590 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003591 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003592 SuppressUserConversions);
3593 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003594 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003595 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
3596 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003597 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003598 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003599 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003600 Args[0]->getType(), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003601 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00003602 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003603 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003604 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003605 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003606 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
3607 SuppressUserConversions);
3608 }
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00003609 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003610}
3611
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003612/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
3613/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003614void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003615 QualType ObjectType,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003616 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3617 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003618 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003619 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003620 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003621
3622 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
3623 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
3624
3625 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
3626 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
3627 "Expected a member function template");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003628 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
3629 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003630 ObjectType, Args, NumArgs,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003631 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003632 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003633 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003634 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003635 ObjectType, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003636 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003637 }
3638}
3639
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003640/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
3641/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
3642/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
3643/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
3644/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
3645/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003646/// operators.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003647void
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003648Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00003649 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
3650 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003651 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003652 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003653 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003654 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003655 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003656 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
3657 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003658
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003659 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
3660 return;
3661
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003662 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00003663 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003664
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003665 // Add this candidate
3666 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3667 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003668 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003669 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003670 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003671 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003672
3673 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3674
3675 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
3676 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
3677 // list (8.3.5).
3678 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
3679 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003680 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003681 return;
3682 }
3683
3684 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
3685 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
3686 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
3687 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
3688 // exactly m parameters.
3689 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
3690 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs) {
3691 // Not enough arguments.
3692 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003693 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003694 return;
3695 }
3696
3697 Candidate.Viable = true;
3698 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
3699
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003700 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003701 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
3702 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
3703 else {
3704 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
3705 // parameter.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003706 Candidate.Conversions[0]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003707 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, Method,
3708 ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003709 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003710 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003711 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003712 return;
3713 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003714 }
3715
3716 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
3717 // arguments.
3718 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
3719 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
3720 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
3721 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
3722 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
3723 // parameter of F.
3724 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003725 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003726 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003727 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00003728 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003729 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003730 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003731 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003732 break;
3733 }
3734 } else {
3735 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
3736 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
3737 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003738 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003739 }
3740 }
3741}
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00003742
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003743/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
3744/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
3745/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003746void
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003747Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003748 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003749 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003750 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003751 QualType ObjectType,
3752 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003753 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003754 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003755 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
3756 return;
3757
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003758 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003759 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003760 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003761 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003762 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
3763 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
3764 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
3765 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
3766 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003767 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003768 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
3769 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003770 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003771 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00003772 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3773 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
3774 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
3775 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
3776 Candidate.Viable = false;
3777 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
3778 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
3779 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
3780 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
3781 Info);
3782 return;
3783 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003784
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003785 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
3786 // deduction as a candidate.
3787 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003788 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003789 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003790 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00003791 ActingContext, ObjectType, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003792 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003793}
3794
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003795/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
3796/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
3797/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003798void
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003799Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003800 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003801 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003802 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3803 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003804 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003805 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
3806 return;
3807
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003808 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003809 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003810 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003811 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003812 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
3813 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
3814 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
3815 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
3816 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003817 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003818 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
3819 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003820 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003821 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00003822 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3823 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003824 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00003825 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
3826 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003827 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00003828 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
3829 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00003830 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
3831 Info);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003832 return;
3833 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003834
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003835 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
3836 // deduction as a candidate.
3837 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003838 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003839 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003840}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003841
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003842/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003843/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003844/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003845/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003846/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
3847/// conversion function produces).
3848void
3849Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003850 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003851 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003852 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3853 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003854 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
3855 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003856 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003857 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
3858 return;
3859
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003860 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00003861 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003862
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003863 // Add this candidate
3864 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3865 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003866 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003867 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003868 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003869 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003870 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003871 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003872 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003873 Candidate.Viable = true;
3874 Candidate.Conversions.resize(1);
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00003875
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00003876 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
3877 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
3878 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
3879 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00003880 //
3881 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
3882 // object parameter.
3883 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
3884 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
3885 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
3886 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
3887 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3888
3889 Candidate.Conversions[0]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003890 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), Conversion,
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00003891 ConversionContext);
3892
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003893 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003894 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003895 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003896 return;
3897 }
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00003898
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00003899 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
3900 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
3901 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
3902 QualType FromCanon
3903 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
3904 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
3905 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
3906 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00003907 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00003908 return;
3909 }
3910
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003911 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
3912 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
3913 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
3914 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
3915 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
3916 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
3917 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
3918 // well-formed.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003919 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003920 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003921 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
3922 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003923 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00003924 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003925
Douglas Gregor72ebdab2010-11-13 19:36:57 +00003926 QualType CallResultType
3927 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
3928 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), CallResultType, 0)) {
3929 Candidate.Viable = false;
3930 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
3931 return;
3932 }
3933
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003934 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(Conversion->getConversionType());
3935
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003936 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003937 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
3938 // allocator).
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00003939 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00003940 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003941 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003942 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00003943 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00003944 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003945
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003946 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003947 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
3948 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00003949
3950 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
3951 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
3952 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
3953 // shall have exact match rank.
3954 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
3955 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
3956 Candidate.Viable = false;
3957 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
3958 }
3959
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003960 break;
3961
3962 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
3963 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00003964 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003965 break;
3966
3967 default:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003968 assert(false &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003969 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
3970 }
3971}
3972
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003973/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
3974/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
3975/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
3976/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
3977/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003978void
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003979Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003980 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003981 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003982 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3983 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
3984 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
3985 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
3986
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003987 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
3988 return;
3989
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003990 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003991 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
3992 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003993 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003994 Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00003995 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3996 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
3997 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
3998 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
3999 Candidate.Viable = false;
4000 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4001 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4002 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
4003 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
4004 Info);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004005 return;
4006 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004007
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004008 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
4009 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
4010 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004011 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004012 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004013}
4014
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004015/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
4016/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
4017/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
4018/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
4019/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
4020void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004021 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004022 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004023 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004024 QualType ObjectType,
4025 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004026 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004027 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4028 return;
4029
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004030 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004031 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004032
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004033 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4034 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004035 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004036 Candidate.Function = 0;
4037 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
4038 Candidate.Viable = true;
4039 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004040 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004041 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
4042
4043 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4044 // object parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004045 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004046 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, Conversion,
4047 ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004048 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004049 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004050 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004051 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004052 return;
4053 }
4054
4055 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
4056 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
4057 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004058 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004059 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00004060 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004061 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004062 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004063 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
4064 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4065
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004066 // Find the
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004067 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4068
4069 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4070 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4071 // list (8.3.5).
4072 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4073 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004074 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004075 return;
4076 }
4077
4078 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
4079 // we have enough arguments.
4080 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
4081 // Not enough arguments.
4082 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004083 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004084 return;
4085 }
4086
4087 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4088 // arguments.
4089 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4090 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4091 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4092 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4093 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4094 // parameter of F.
4095 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004096 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004097 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004098 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004099 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004100 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004101 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004102 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004103 break;
4104 }
4105 } else {
4106 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4107 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4108 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004109 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004110 }
4111 }
4112}
4113
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004114/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
4115/// member functions.
4116///
4117/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
4118/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
4119/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
4120/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
4121/// [over.match.oper]).
4122void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
4123 SourceLocation OpLoc,
4124 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4125 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4126 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004127 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
4128
4129 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
4130 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
4131 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
4132 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
4133 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
4134 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
4135 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
4136 // constructed as follows:
4137 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004138
4139 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
4140 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
4141 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
4142 // empty.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004143 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004144 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00004145 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag()))
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004146 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004147
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00004148 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
4149 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
4150 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
4151
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004152 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004153 OperEnd = Operators.end();
4154 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004155 ++Oper)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004156 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004157 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004158 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004159 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004160}
4161
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004162/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
4163/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
4164/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004165/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
4166/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004167/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
4168/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
4169/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004170void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004171 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004172 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004173 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
4174 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004175 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004176 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004177
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004178 // Add this candidate
4179 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4180 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004181 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004182 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00004183 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004184 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004185 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
4186 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
4187 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
4188
4189 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4190 // arguments.
4191 Candidate.Viable = true;
4192 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
4193 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004194 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
4195 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
4196 // left operand are restricted as follows:
4197 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
4198 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
4199 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004200 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004201 //
4202 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
4203 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
4204 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
4205 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004206 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004207 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004208 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004209 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
4210 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004211 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004212 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004213 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004214 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004215 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004216 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004217 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004218 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004219 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004220 break;
4221 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004222 }
4223}
4224
4225/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
4226/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
4227/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
4228/// enumeration types.
4229class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
4230 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004231 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004232
4233 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
4234 /// built-in candidates.
4235 TypeSet PointerTypes;
4236
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004237 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
4238 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4239 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
4240
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004241 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
4242 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4243 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
4244
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004245 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
4246 /// candidates.
4247 TypeSet VectorTypes;
4248
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004249 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
4250 /// candidate type set.
4251 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004252
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004253 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
4254 ASTContext &Context;
4255
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004256 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4257 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004258 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004259
4260public:
4261 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004262 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004263
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004264 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004265 : SemaRef(SemaRef), Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004266
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004267 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
4268 SourceLocation Loc,
4269 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004270 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4271 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004272
4273 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
4274 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
4275
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004276 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004277 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
4278
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004279 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
4280 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
4281
4282 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
4283 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
4284
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004285 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
4286 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
4287
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004288 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004289 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004290
4291 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
4292 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004293};
4294
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004295/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004296/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4297/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4298/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4299/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4300/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4301/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004302///
4303/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004304bool
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004305BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4306 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004307
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004308 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004309 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004310 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004311
4312 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004313 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004314 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004315 if (!PointerTy) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004316 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004317 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004318 buildObjCPtr = true;
4319 }
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004320 else
4321 assert(false && "type was not a pointer type!");
4322 }
4323 else
4324 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
4325
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004326 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4327 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4328 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4329 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4330 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4331 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004332 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor4ef1d402009-11-09 22:08:55 +00004333 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy))
Fariborz Jahanianfacfdd42009-11-09 21:02:05 +00004334 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004335 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
4336 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
4337
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004338 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
4339 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4340 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004341 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere
4342 // in the types.
4343 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
4344 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004345 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004346 if (!buildObjCPtr)
4347 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy));
4348 else
4349 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy));
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004350 }
4351
4352 return true;
4353}
4354
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004355/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
4356/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4357/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4358/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4359/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4360/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4361/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004362///
4363/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004364bool
4365BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
4366 QualType Ty) {
4367 // Insert this type.
4368 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
4369 return false;
4370
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004371 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4372 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004373
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004374 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004375 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4376 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4377 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4378 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4379 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4380 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004381 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
4382
4383 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
4384 // qualifiers.
4385 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
4386 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4387 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
4388
4389 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004390 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
4391 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004392 }
4393
4394 return true;
4395}
4396
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004397/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
4398/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004399/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
4400/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004401/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
4402/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
4403/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
4404/// type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004405void
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004406BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004407 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004408 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004409 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4410 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004411 // Only deal with canonical types.
4412 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
4413
4414 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
4415 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004416 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004417 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
4418
4419 // We don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004420 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004421
Sebastian Redl65ae2002009-11-05 16:36:20 +00004422 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
4423 if (Ty->isArrayType())
4424 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004425 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
4426 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
4427 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004428 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
4429 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004430 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004431 return;
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004432 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
4433 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
4434 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
4435 return;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004436 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004437 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004438 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
4439 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004440 } else if (AllowUserConversions) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004441 if (const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004442 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004443 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
4444 return;
4445 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004446
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004447 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004448 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianae01f782009-10-07 17:26:09 +00004449 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004450 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00004451 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00004452 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4453 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4454 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004455
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004456 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004457 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00004458 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004459 continue;
4460
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00004461 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004462 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004463 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004464 VisibleQuals);
4465 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004466 }
4467 }
4468 }
4469}
4470
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004471/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
4472/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
4473/// given type to the candidate set.
4474static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
4475 QualType T,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004476 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004477 unsigned NumArgs,
4478 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4479 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004480
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004481 // T& operator=(T&, T)
4482 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
4483 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4484 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4485 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004486
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004487 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
4488 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004489 ParamTypes[0]
4490 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004491 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4492 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004493 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004494 }
4495}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004496
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004497/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
4498/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004499static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
4500 Qualifiers VRQuals;
4501 const RecordType *TyRec;
4502 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
4503 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregord0ace022010-04-25 00:55:24 +00004504 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004505 else
4506 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
4507 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004508 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004509 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4510 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4511 return VRQuals;
4512 }
4513
4514 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall67da35c2010-02-04 22:26:26 +00004515 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
4516 return VRQuals;
4517
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004518 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004519 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004520
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004521 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00004522 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00004523 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4524 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4525 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4526 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004527 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
4528 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
4529 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
4530 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
4531 // as see them.
4532 bool done = false;
4533 while (!done) {
4534 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
4535 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
4536 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
4537 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
4538 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
4539 else
4540 done = true;
4541 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
4542 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4543 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
4544 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4545 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
4546 return VRQuals;
4547 }
4548 }
4549 }
4550 return VRQuals;
4551}
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004552
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004553namespace {
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004554
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004555/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
4556/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
4557/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
4558/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
4559class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
4560
4561 // FIXME: Clean up and document the static helpers for arithmetic types here.
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004562 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
4563 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004564 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
4565 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18;
4566 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
4567 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9;
4568 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
4569 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9;
4570 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18;
4571
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004572 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes];
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004573
4574 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
4575 // The rules are basically:
4576 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
4577 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
4578 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
4579 // - use the larger type
4580 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
4581 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
4582 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
4583 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
4584 // better not to make any assumptions).
4585 enum PromT { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1 };
4586 static PromT UsualArithmeticConversionsTypes
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004587 [LastPromotedArithmeticType][LastPromotedArithmeticType];
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004588 struct UsualArithmeticConversionsType {
4589 static CanQualType find(ASTContext &C, unsigned L, unsigned R) {
4590 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
4591 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
4592 signed char Idx = UsualArithmeticConversionsTypes[L][R];
4593
4594 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
4595 if (Idx != Dep) return C.*ArithmeticTypes[Idx];
4596
4597 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
4598 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
4599 CanQualType LT = C.*ArithmeticTypes[L], RT = C.*ArithmeticTypes[R];
4600 unsigned LW = C.getIntWidth(LT), RW = C.getIntWidth(RT);
4601
4602 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
4603 if (LW > RW) return LT;
4604 else if (LW > RW) return RT;
4605
4606 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
4607 if (L == SL || R == SL) return C.UnsignedLongTy;
4608 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
4609 return C.UnsignedLongLongTy;
4610 }
4611 };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004612
4613 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
4614 Sema &S;
4615 Expr **Args;
4616 unsigned NumArgs;
4617 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
4618 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
4619 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
4620
4621 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
4622 bool HasVolatile) {
4623 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
4624 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
4625 S.Context.IntTy
4626 };
4627
4628 // Non-volatile version.
4629 if (NumArgs == 1)
4630 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4631 else
4632 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4633
4634 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
4635 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
4636 if (HasVolatile) {
4637 ParamTypes[0] =
4638 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
4639 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
4640 if (NumArgs == 1)
4641 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4642 else
4643 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4644 }
4645 }
4646
4647public:
4648 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
4649 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4650 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
4651 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
4652 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
4653 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
4654 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
4655 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
4656 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
4657 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
4658 assert(ArithmeticTypes[FirstPromotedIntegralType] == &ASTContext::IntTy &&
4659 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
4660 assert(ArithmeticTypes[LastPromotedIntegralType - 1]
4661 == &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy &&
4662 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
4663 assert(ArithmeticTypes[FirstPromotedArithmeticType]
4664 == &ASTContext::FloatTy &&
4665 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
4666 assert(ArithmeticTypes[LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1]
4667 == &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy &&
4668 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
4669 }
4670
4671 // C++ [over.built]p3:
4672 //
4673 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
4674 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
4675 // functions of the form
4676 //
4677 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
4678 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
4679 //
4680 // C++ [over.built]p4:
4681 //
4682 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
4683 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
4684 // candidate operator functions of the form
4685 //
4686 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
4687 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
4688 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
4689 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
4690 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
4691 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
4692 S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Arith],
4693 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile());
4694 }
4695 }
4696
4697 // C++ [over.built]p5:
4698 //
4699 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
4700 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
4701 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
4702 //
4703 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
4704 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
4705 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
4706 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
4707 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
4708 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4709 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
4710 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
4711 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
4712 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
4713 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
4714 continue;
4715
4716 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
4717 (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
4718 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()));
4719 }
4720 }
4721
4722 // C++ [over.built]p6:
4723 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
4724 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
4725 //
4726 // T& operator*(T*);
4727 //
4728 // C++ [over.built]p7:
4729 // For every function type T, there exist candidate operator
4730 // functions of the form
4731 // T& operator*(T*);
4732 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
4733 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4734 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
4735 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
4736 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
4737 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
4738 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
4739 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
4740 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4741 }
4742 }
4743
4744 // C++ [over.built]p9:
4745 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
4746 // operator functions of the form
4747 //
4748 // T operator+(T);
4749 // T operator-(T);
4750 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
4751 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
4752 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
4753 QualType ArithTy = S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Arith];
4754 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4755 }
4756
4757 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
4758 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4759 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
4760 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
4761 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
4762 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
4763 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4764 }
4765 }
4766
4767 // C++ [over.built]p8:
4768 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
4769 // the form
4770 //
4771 // T* operator+(T*);
4772 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
4773 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4774 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
4775 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
4776 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
4777 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
4778 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4779 }
4780 }
4781
4782 // C++ [over.built]p10:
4783 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
4784 // operator functions of the form
4785 //
4786 // T operator~(T);
4787 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
4788 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
4789 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
4790 QualType IntTy = S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Int];
4791 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4792 }
4793
4794 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
4795 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4796 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
4797 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
4798 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
4799 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
4800 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4801 }
4802 }
4803
4804 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
4805 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
4806 // functions of the form
4807 //
4808 // bool operator==(T,T);
4809 // bool operator!=(T,T);
4810 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
4811 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
4812 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
4813
4814 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4815 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4816 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
4817 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
4818 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
4819 ++MemPtr) {
4820 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
4821 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
4822 continue;
4823
4824 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
4825 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
4826 CandidateSet);
4827 }
4828 }
4829 }
4830
4831 // C++ [over.built]p15:
4832 //
4833 // For every pointer or enumeration type T, there exist
4834 // candidate operator functions of the form
4835 //
4836 // bool operator<(T, T);
4837 // bool operator>(T, T);
4838 // bool operator<=(T, T);
4839 // bool operator>=(T, T);
4840 // bool operator==(T, T);
4841 // bool operator!=(T, T);
4842 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(
4843 const llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
4844 &UserDefinedBinaryOperators) {
4845 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
4846 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
4847
4848 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4849 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4850 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
4851 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
4852 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
4853 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
4854 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
4855 continue;
4856
4857 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
4858 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
4859 CandidateSet);
4860 }
4861 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4862 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
4863 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
4864 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
4865 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
4866
4867 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
4868 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType))
4869 continue;
4870
4871 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
4872 if (!UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(
4873 std::make_pair(CanonType, CanonType)))
4874 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
4875 CandidateSet);
4876 }
4877 }
4878 }
4879
4880 // C++ [over.built]p13:
4881 //
4882 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
4883 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
4884 //
4885 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
4886 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
4887 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
4888 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
4889 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
4890 //
4891 // C++ [over.built]p14:
4892 //
4893 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
4894 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
4895 //
4896 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
4897 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
4898 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
4899 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
4900
4901 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
4902 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
4903 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
4904 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
4905 };
4906 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4907 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
4908 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
4909 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
4910 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
4911 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
4912 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
4913 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
4914 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
4915 CandidateSet);
4916 }
4917 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
4918 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
4919 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
4920 continue;
4921
4922 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
4923 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
4924 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4925 }
4926 }
4927 }
4928 }
4929
4930 // C++ [over.built]p12:
4931 //
4932 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
4933 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
4934 //
4935 // LR operator*(L, R);
4936 // LR operator/(L, R);
4937 // LR operator+(L, R);
4938 // LR operator-(L, R);
4939 // bool operator<(L, R);
4940 // bool operator>(L, R);
4941 // bool operator<=(L, R);
4942 // bool operator>=(L, R);
4943 // bool operator==(L, R);
4944 // bool operator!=(L, R);
4945 //
4946 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
4947 // between types L and R.
4948 //
4949 // C++ [over.built]p24:
4950 //
4951 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
4952 // candidate operator functions of the form
4953 //
4954 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
4955 //
4956 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
4957 // between types L and R.
4958 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
4959 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
4960 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
4961 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
4962 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
4963 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
4964 QualType LandR[2] = { S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Left],
4965 S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
4966 QualType Result =
4967 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
4968 : UsualArithmeticConversionsType::find(S.Context, Left,
4969 Right);
4970 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4971 }
4972 }
4973
4974 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
4975 // conditional operator for vector types.
4976 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4977 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
4978 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
4979 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
4980 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4981 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
4982 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
4983 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
4984 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
4985 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
4986 if (!isComparison) {
4987 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
4988 Result = *Vec1;
4989 else
4990 Result = *Vec2;
4991 }
4992
4993 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4994 }
4995 }
4996 }
4997
4998 // C++ [over.built]p17:
4999 //
5000 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
5001 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5002 //
5003 // LR operator%(L, R);
5004 // LR operator&(L, R);
5005 // LR operator^(L, R);
5006 // LR operator|(L, R);
5007 // L operator<<(L, R);
5008 // L operator>>(L, R);
5009 //
5010 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5011 // between types L and R.
5012 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
5013 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5014 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
5015 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5016 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
5017 QualType LandR[2] = { S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Left],
5018 S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
5019 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
5020 ? LandR[0]
5021 : UsualArithmeticConversionsType::find(S.Context, Left, Right);
5022 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5023 }
5024 }
5025 }
5026
5027 // C++ [over.built]p20:
5028 //
5029 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
5030 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
5031 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5032 //
5033 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
5034 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5035 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5036 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5037
5038 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5039 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5040 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5041 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5042 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5043 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5044 continue;
5045
5046 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
5047 CandidateSet);
5048 }
5049
5050 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5051 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5052 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5053 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5054 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5055 continue;
5056
5057 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
5058 CandidateSet);
5059 }
5060 }
5061 }
5062
5063 // C++ [over.built]p19:
5064 //
5065 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
5066 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
5067 // of the form
5068 //
5069 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
5070 //
5071 // C++ [over.built]p21:
5072 //
5073 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5074 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
5075 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5076 //
5077 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5078 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5079 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
5080 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5081 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5082
5083 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5084 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5085 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5086 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5087 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
5088 if (isEqualOp)
5089 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
5090
5091 // non-volatile version
5092 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5093 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5094 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5095 };
5096 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5097 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
5098
5099 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5100 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5101 // volatile version
5102 ParamTypes[0] =
5103 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
5104 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5105 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5106 }
5107 }
5108
5109 if (isEqualOp) {
5110 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5111 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5112 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5113 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5114 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
5115 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5116 continue;
5117
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005118 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5119 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5120 *Ptr,
5121 };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005122
5123 // non-volatile version
5124 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5125 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
5126
5127 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5128 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5129 // volatile version
5130 ParamTypes[0] =
5131 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005132 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5133 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005134 }
5135 }
5136 }
5137 }
5138
5139 // C++ [over.built]p18:
5140 //
5141 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
5142 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
5143 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
5144 // the form
5145 //
5146 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
5147 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
5148 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
5149 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
5150 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
5151 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
5152 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
5153 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5154 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
5155 QualType ParamTypes[2];
5156 ParamTypes[1] = S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Right];
5157
5158 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5159 ParamTypes[0] =
5160 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Left]);
5161 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5162 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5163
5164 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5165 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5166 ParamTypes[0] =
5167 S.Context.getVolatileType(S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Left]);
5168 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005169 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5170 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005171 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5172 }
5173 }
5174 }
5175
5176 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
5177 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5178 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5179 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5180 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5181 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5182 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5183 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5184 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5185 QualType ParamTypes[2];
5186 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
5187 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5188 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
5189 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5190 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5191
5192 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5193 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5194 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
5195 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005196 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5197 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005198 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5199 }
5200 }
5201 }
5202 }
5203
5204 // C++ [over.built]p22:
5205 //
5206 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
5207 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
5208 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5209 //
5210 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
5211 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
5212 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
5213 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
5214 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
5215 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
5216 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
5217 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
5218 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5219 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
5220 QualType ParamTypes[2];
5221 ParamTypes[1] = S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Right];
5222
5223 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5224 ParamTypes[0] =
5225 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Left]);
5226 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5227 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5228 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5229 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[Left];
5230 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
5231 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
5232 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5233 CandidateSet);
5234 }
5235 }
5236 }
5237 }
5238
5239 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
5240 //
5241 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
5242 //
5243 // bool operator!(bool);
5244 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
5245 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
5246 void addExclaimOverload() {
5247 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
5248 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
5249 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
5250 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
5251 }
5252 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
5253 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
5254 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5255 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
5256 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
5257 }
5258
5259 // C++ [over.built]p13:
5260 //
5261 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
5262 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5263 //
5264 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5265 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
5266 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5267 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
5268 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
5269 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
5270 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5271 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5272 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5273 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5274 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
5275 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
5276 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
5277
5278 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
5279 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5280 }
5281
5282 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5283 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5284 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5285 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5286 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
5287 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
5288 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
5289
5290 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
5291 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5292 }
5293 }
5294
5295 // C++ [over.built]p11:
5296 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
5297 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
5298 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
5299 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5300 //
5301 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
5302 //
5303 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
5304 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
5305 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5306 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5307 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5308 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5309 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
5310 QualType C1;
5311 QualifierCollector Q1;
5312 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
5313 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
5314 continue;
5315 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
5316 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
5317 // volatile/restrict type.
5318 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
5319 continue;
5320 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
5321 continue;
5322 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5323 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
5324 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
5325 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5326 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
5327 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
5328 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
5329 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
5330 break;
5331 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
5332 // build CV12 T&
5333 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
5334 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
5335 T.isVolatileQualified())
5336 continue;
5337 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
5338 T.isRestrictQualified())
5339 continue;
5340 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
5341 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
5342 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5343 }
5344 }
5345 }
5346
5347 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
5348 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
5349 // therefore added as binary.
5350 //
5351 // C++ [over.built]p25:
5352 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
5353 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5354 //
5355 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
5356 //
5357 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
5358 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5359 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5360
5361 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5362 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5363 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5364 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5365 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5366 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5367 continue;
5368
5369 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5370 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5371 }
5372
5373 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5374 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5375 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5376 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5377 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5378 continue;
5379
5380 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
5381 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5382 }
5383
5384 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) {
5385 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5386 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5387 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5388 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5389 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
5390 continue;
5391
5392 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5393 continue;
5394
5395 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
5396 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5397 }
5398 }
5399 }
5400 }
5401};
5402
5403CanQualType ASTContext::* const
5404BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder::ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
5405 // Start of promoted types.
5406 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
5407 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
5408 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
5409
5410 // Start of integral types.
5411 &ASTContext::IntTy,
5412 &ASTContext::LongTy,
5413 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
5414 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
5415 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
5416 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
5417 // End of promoted types.
5418
5419 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
5420 &ASTContext::CharTy,
5421 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
5422 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
5423 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
5424 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
5425 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
5426 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
5427 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy
5428 // End of integral types.
5429 // FIXME: What about complex?
5430};
5431
5432// Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
5433// The rules are basically:
5434// - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
5435// - if same signedness, use the higher rank
5436// - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
5437// - use the larger type
5438// These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
5439// never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
5440// *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
5441// (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
5442// better not to make any assumptions).
5443BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder::PromT
5444BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder::UsualArithmeticConversionsTypes
5445[LastPromotedArithmeticType][LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
5446 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
5447 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
5448 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
5449 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL },
5450 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL },
5451 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL },
5452 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL },
5453 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL },
5454 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL }
5455};
5456
5457} // end anonymous namespace
5458
5459/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
5460/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
5461/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
5462/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
5463/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
5464void
5465Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
5466 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5467 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5468 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005469 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
5470 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
5471 // that make use of these types.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005472 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
5473 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00005474 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
5475 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
5476
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00005477 llvm::SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
5478 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5479 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
5480 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
5481 OpLoc,
5482 true,
5483 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
5484 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
5485 Op == OO_PipePipe),
5486 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
5487 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005488
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +00005489 // C++ [over.built]p1:
5490 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter
5491 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator
5492 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate functions.
5493 //
5494 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end
5495 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for
5496 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem,
5497 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for.
5498 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
5499 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005500
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00005501 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5502 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin()
5503 != CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
5504 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
5505 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
5506 C != CEnd; ++C) {
5507 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
5508 continue;
5509
5510 // Check if the first parameter is of enumeration type.
5511 QualType FirstParamType
5512 = C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5513 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType())
5514 continue;
5515
5516 // Check if the second parameter is of enumeration type.
5517 QualType SecondParamType
5518 = C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5519 if (!SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
5520 continue;
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +00005521
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00005522 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
5523 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
5524 std::make_pair(Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
5525 Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
5526 }
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +00005527 }
5528 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005529
5530 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
5531 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
5532 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
5533 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
5534
5535 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005536 switch (Op) {
5537 case OO_None:
5538 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
5539 assert(false && "Expected an overloaded operator");
5540 break;
5541
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00005542 case OO_New:
5543 case OO_Delete:
5544 case OO_Array_New:
5545 case OO_Array_Delete:
5546 case OO_Call:
5547 assert(false && "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
5548 break;
5549
5550 case OO_Comma:
5551 case OO_Arrow:
5552 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5553 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
5554 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005555 break;
5556
5557 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00005558 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005559 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00005560 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005561
5562 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00005563 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005564 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00005565 } else {
5566 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
5567 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
5568 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005569 break;
5570
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00005571 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005572 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00005573 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
5574 else
5575 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
5576 break;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005577
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00005578 case OO_Slash:
5579 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00005580 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005581
5582 case OO_PlusPlus:
5583 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005584 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
5585 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005586 break;
5587
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00005588 case OO_EqualEqual:
5589 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005590 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00005591 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00005592
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005593 case OO_Less:
5594 case OO_Greater:
5595 case OO_LessEqual:
5596 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005597 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads(
5598 UserDefinedBinaryOperators);
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00005599 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
5600 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005601
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005602 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005603 case OO_Caret:
5604 case OO_Pipe:
5605 case OO_LessLess:
5606 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005607 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005608 break;
5609
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00005610 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
5611 if (NumArgs == 1)
5612 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5613 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
5614 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
5615 break;
5616
5617 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
5618 break;
5619
5620 case OO_Tilde:
5621 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
5622 break;
5623
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005624 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005625 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005626 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005627
5628 case OO_PlusEqual:
5629 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005630 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005631 // Fall through.
5632
5633 case OO_StarEqual:
5634 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005635 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005636 break;
5637
5638 case OO_PercentEqual:
5639 case OO_LessLessEqual:
5640 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
5641 case OO_AmpEqual:
5642 case OO_CaretEqual:
5643 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005644 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005645 break;
5646
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005647 case OO_Exclaim:
5648 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005649 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00005650
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005651 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005652 case OO_PipePipe:
5653 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005654 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005655
5656 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005657 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005658 break;
5659
5660 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005661 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005662 break;
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005663
5664 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005665 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00005666 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
5667 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005668 }
5669}
5670
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005671/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
5672/// to the set of overloading candidates.
5673///
5674/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
5675/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
5676/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
5677/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005678void
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005679Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005680 bool Operator,
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005681 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005682 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005683 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5684 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005685 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005686
John McCall91f61fc2010-01-26 06:04:06 +00005687 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
5688 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
5689 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
5690 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
5691 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
5692 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
5693
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005694 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005695 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Args, NumArgs, Fns);
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005696
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00005697 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00005698 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
5699 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
5700 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005701 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005702 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005703 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005704 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005705 }
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00005706
5707 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
5708 // set.
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005709 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005710 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005711 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005712 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005713 continue;
5714
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005715 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00005716 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005717 } else
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005718 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005719 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00005720 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005721 }
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005722}
5723
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005724/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
5725/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005726bool
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005727isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00005728 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
5729 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00005730 SourceLocation Loc,
5731 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005732 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
5733 // functions.
5734 if (!Cand2.Viable)
5735 return Cand1.Viable;
5736 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
5737 return false;
5738
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005739 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
5740 //
5741 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
5742 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
5743 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
5744 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
5745 unsigned StartArg = 0;
5746 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
5747 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005748
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005749 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005750 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
5751 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005752 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005753 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
5754 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
5755 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005756 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005757 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
5758 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005759 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
5760 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
5761 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
5762 HasBetterConversion = true;
5763 break;
5764
5765 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
5766 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
5767 return false;
5768
5769 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
5770 // Do nothing.
5771 break;
5772 }
5773 }
5774
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005775 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005776 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005777 if (HasBetterConversion)
5778 return true;
5779
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005780 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005781 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorce21919b2010-06-08 21:03:17 +00005782 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005783 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
5784 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005785
5786 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
5787 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
5788 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005789 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor55137cb2009-08-02 23:46:29 +00005790 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
5791 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005792 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005793 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
5794 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
5795 Loc,
Douglas Gregor6010da02009-09-14 23:02:14 +00005796 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
5797 : TPOC_Call))
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005798 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005799
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005800 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
5801 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
5802 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
5803 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
5804 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
5805 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00005806 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005807 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005808 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005809 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
5810 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005811 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
5812 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
5813 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
5814 return true;
5815
5816 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
5817 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
5818 return false;
5819
5820 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
5821 // Do nothing
5822 break;
5823 }
5824 }
5825
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005826 return false;
5827}
5828
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005829/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00005830/// within an overload candidate set.
5831///
5832/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions.
5833///
5834/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
5835/// which overload resolution occurs.
5836///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005837/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00005838/// function, Best points to the candidate function found.
5839///
5840/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005841OverloadingResult
5842OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00005843 iterator &Best,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00005844 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005845 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005846 Best = end();
5847 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
5848 if (Cand->Viable)
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00005849 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
5850 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005851 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005852 }
5853
5854 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005855 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005856 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
5857
5858 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
5859 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005860 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005861 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005862 Cand != Best &&
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00005863 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
5864 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005865 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005866 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005867 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005868 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005869
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005870 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00005871 if (Best->Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005872 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005873 Best->Function->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00005874 return OR_Deleted;
5875
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00005876 // C++ [basic.def.odr]p2:
5877 // An overloaded function is used if it is selected by overload resolution
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005878 // when referred to from a potentially-evaluated expression. [Note: this
5879 // covers calls to named functions (5.2.2), operator overloading
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00005880 // (clause 13), user-defined conversions (12.3.2), allocation function for
5881 // placement new (5.3.4), as well as non-default initialization (8.5).
5882 if (Best->Function)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005883 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Best->Function);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00005884
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005885 return OR_Success;
5886}
5887
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005888namespace {
5889
5890enum OverloadCandidateKind {
5891 oc_function,
5892 oc_method,
5893 oc_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005894 oc_function_template,
5895 oc_method_template,
5896 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005897 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
5898 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005899 oc_implicit_copy_assignment
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005900};
5901
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005902OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
5903 FunctionDecl *Fn,
5904 std::string &Description) {
5905 bool isTemplate = false;
5906
5907 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
5908 isTemplate = true;
5909 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
5910 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
5911 }
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00005912
5913 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005914 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005915 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00005916
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005917 return Ctor->isCopyConstructor() ? oc_implicit_copy_constructor
5918 : oc_implicit_default_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00005919 }
5920
5921 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
5922 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
5923 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005924 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005925 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00005926
Douglas Gregorec3bec02010-09-27 22:37:28 +00005927 assert(Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00005928 && "implicit method is not copy assignment operator?");
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005929 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
5930 }
5931
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005932 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005933}
5934
5935} // end anonymous namespace
5936
5937// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
5938void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005939 std::string FnDesc;
5940 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
5941 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate)
5942 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00005943}
5944
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005945/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
5946/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
5947/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005948void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
5949 Sema &S,
5950 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
5951 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
5952 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
5953 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005954 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005955 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
5956 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005957 }
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005958}
5959
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005960namespace {
5961
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005962void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
5963 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
5964 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005965 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
5966 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
5967
5968 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
5969 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
5970 // conversion-slot index.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005971 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005972 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005973 if (I == 0)
5974 isObjectArgument = true;
5975 else
5976 I--;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005977 }
5978
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005979 std::string FnDesc;
5980 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
5981
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005982 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
5983 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
5984 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005985
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00005986 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00005987 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00005988 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
5989 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
5990 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00005991 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00005992
5993 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
5994 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
5995 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
5996 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
5997 return;
5998 }
5999
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006000 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
6001 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006002 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
6003 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
6004 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6005 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
6006 else {
6007 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
6008 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6009 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6010 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
6011 }
6012
6013 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
6014 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
6015 // It is dumb that we have to do this here.
6016 while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy))
6017 CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6018 while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy))
6019 CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6020
6021 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
6022 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
6023
6024 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
6025 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
6026 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6027 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6028 << FromTy
6029 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
6030 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
6031 return;
6032 }
6033
6034 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
6035 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
6036
6037 if (isObjectArgument) {
6038 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
6039 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6040 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6041 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
6042 } else {
6043 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
6044 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6045 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6046 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
6047 }
6048 return;
6049 }
6050
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006051 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
6052 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
6053 // the failure.
6054 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
6055 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6056 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6057 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
6058 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
6059 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6060 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6061 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
6062 return;
6063 }
6064
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006065 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006066 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006067 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6068 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6069 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6070 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6071 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6072 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6073 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
6074 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006075 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006076 }
6077 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
6078 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
6079 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
6080 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6081 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6082 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6083 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6084 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6085 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006086 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
6087 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
6088 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
6089 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
6090 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6091 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy))
6092 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
6093 }
6094
6095 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006096 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006097 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006098 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6099 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006100 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006101 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
6102 return;
6103 }
6104
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006105 // TODO: specialize more based on the kind of mismatch
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006106 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv)
6107 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006108 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
John McCalla1709fd2010-01-14 00:56:20 +00006109 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006110}
6111
6112void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6113 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
6114 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
6115
6116 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6117 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6118
6119 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
6120
6121 // at least / at most / exactly
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006122 // FIXME: variadic templates "at most" should account for parameter packs
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006123 unsigned mode, modeCount;
6124 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006125 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
6126 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
6127 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006128 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() || FnTy->isVariadic())
6129 mode = 0; // "at least"
6130 else
6131 mode = 2; // "exactly"
6132 modeCount = MinParams;
6133 } else {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006134 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
6135 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
6136 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006137 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
6138 mode = 1; // "at most"
6139 else
6140 mode = 2; // "exactly"
6141 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
6142 }
6143
6144 std::string Description;
6145 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
6146
6147 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006148 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
6149 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006150}
6151
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006152/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
6153void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6154 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
6155 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
6156
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006157 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006158 NamedDecl *ParamD;
6159 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
6160 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
6161 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006162 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
6163 case Sema::TDK_Success:
6164 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
6165
6166 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006167 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
6168 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
6169 << ParamD->getDeclName();
6170 return;
6171 }
6172
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006173 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
6174 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
6175 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
6176
6177 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
6178
6179 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
6180 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00006181 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006182 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00006183 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006184 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
6185
6186 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
6187 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
6188 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
6189 // done on dependent types).
6190 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
6191
6192 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
6193 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
6194 return;
6195 }
6196
6197 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006198 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006199 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006200 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006201 which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006202 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006203 which = 1;
6204 else {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006205 which = 2;
6206 }
6207
6208 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
6209 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
6210 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
6211 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
6212 return;
6213 }
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006214
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006215 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
6216 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
6217 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
6218 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
6219 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
6220 << ParamD->getDeclName();
6221 else {
6222 int index = 0;
6223 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
6224 index = TTP->getIndex();
6225 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
6226 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
6227 index = NTTP->getIndex();
6228 else
6229 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
6230 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
6231 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
6232 << (index + 1);
6233 }
6234 return;
6235
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006236 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
6237 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
6238 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
6239 return;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006240
6241 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
6242 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
6243 return;
6244
6245 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
6246 std::string ArgString;
6247 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args
6248 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList())
6249 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
6250 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(),
6251 *Args);
6252 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
6253 << ArgString;
6254 return;
6255 }
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006256
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006257 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
6258 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006259 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006260 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
6261 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
6262 return;
6263 }
6264}
6265
6266/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
6267/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
6268///
6269/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
6270/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
6271/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
6272/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
6273/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
6274/// overload.
6275///
6276/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
6277/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
6278/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006279void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6280 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006281 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6282
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006283 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006284 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() || Fn->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>())) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006285 std::string FnDesc;
6286 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006287
6288 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006289 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted();
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006290 return;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006291 }
6292
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006293 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
6294 if (Cand->Viable) {
6295 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
6296 return;
6297 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006298
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006299 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
6300 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
6301 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
6302 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006303
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006304 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006305 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
6306
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006307 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
6308 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006309 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006310 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006311
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006312 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
6313 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
6314 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006315 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
6316 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
6317
6318 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
6319 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
6320 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
6321 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006322 }
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006323 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006324}
6325
6326void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6327 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
6328 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
6329 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
6330 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
6331 bool isLValueReference = false;
6332 bool isRValueReference = false;
6333 bool isPointer = false;
6334 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
6335 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
6336 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6337 isLValueReference = true;
6338 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
6339 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
6340 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6341 isRValueReference = true;
6342 }
6343 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6344 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
6345 isPointer = true;
6346 }
6347 // Desugar down to a function type.
6348 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
6349 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
6350 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
6351 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
6352 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
6353
6354 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
6355 << FnType;
6356}
6357
6358void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
6359 const char *Opc,
6360 SourceLocation OpLoc,
6361 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6362 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
6363 std::string TypeStr("operator");
6364 TypeStr += Opc;
6365 TypeStr += "(";
6366 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
6367 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
6368 TypeStr += ")";
6369 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
6370 } else {
6371 TypeStr += ", ";
6372 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
6373 TypeStr += ")";
6374 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
6375 }
6376}
6377
6378void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6379 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6380 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->Conversions.size();
6381 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
6382 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006383 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
6384 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
6385
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006386 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006387 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006388 }
6389}
6390
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006391SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6392 if (Cand->Function)
6393 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00006394 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006395 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
6396 return SourceLocation();
6397}
6398
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006399struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
6400 Sema &S;
6401 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006402
6403 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
6404 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00006405 // Fast-path this check.
6406 if (L == R) return false;
6407
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006408 // Order first by viability.
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006409 if (L->Viable) {
6410 if (!R->Viable) return true;
6411
6412 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
6413 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
6414 // that could exploit it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006415 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
6416 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006417 } else if (R->Viable)
6418 return false;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006419
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006420 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006421
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006422 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
6423 if (!L->Viable) {
6424 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
6425 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
6426 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
6427 return false;
6428 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
6429 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
6430 return true;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006431
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006432 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
6433 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
6434 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
6435 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
6436 return true;
6437
6438 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
6439 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
6440 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
6441
6442 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall21b57fa2010-02-25 10:46:05 +00006443 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
6444 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006445 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
6446 L->Conversions[I],
6447 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006448 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6449 leftBetter++;
6450 break;
6451
6452 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6453 leftBetter--;
6454 break;
6455
6456 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6457 break;
6458 }
6459 }
6460 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
6461 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
6462
6463 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
6464 return false;
6465
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006466 // TODO: others?
6467 }
6468
6469 // Sort everything else by location.
6470 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
6471 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
6472
6473 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
6474 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
6475 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
6476
6477 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006478 }
6479};
6480
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006481/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
6482/// computes up to the first
6483void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6484 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
6485 assert(!Cand->Viable);
6486
6487 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
6488 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
6489
6490 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006491 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006492 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
6493 while (true) {
6494 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
6495 ConvIdx++;
6496 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad())
6497 break;
6498 }
6499
6500 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
6501 return;
6502
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006503 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
6504 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
6505
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00006506 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006507 // operation somehow.
6508 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006509
6510 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
6511 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
6512
6513 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
6514 QualType ConvType
6515 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6516 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
6517 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
6518 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6519 ArgIdx--;
6520 } else if (Cand->Function) {
6521 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6522 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
6523 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
6524 ArgIdx--;
6525 } else {
6526 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
6527 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
6528 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
6529 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006530 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
6531 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
6532 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006533 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006534 return;
6535 }
6536
6537 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
6538 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
6539 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
6540 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto)
6541 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006542 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
6543 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006544 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006545 else
6546 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
6547 }
6548}
6549
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006550} // end anonymous namespace
6551
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006552/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
6553/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006554/// set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006555void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
6556 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
6557 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6558 const char *Opc,
6559 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006560 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
6561 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
6562 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006563 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
6564 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006565 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006566 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006567 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006568 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00006569 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
6570 Cands.push_back(Cand);
6571 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
6572 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006573 }
6574 }
6575
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006576 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006577 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006578
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006579 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006580
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006581 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006582 const Diagnostic::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00006583 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006584 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6585 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor4fc308b2008-11-21 02:54:28 +00006586
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00006587 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
6588 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
6589 // candidate list.
6590 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Diagnostic::Ovl_Best) {
6591 break;
6592 }
6593 ++CandsShown;
6594
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006595 if (Cand->Function)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006596 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006597 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006598 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00006599 else {
6600 assert(Cand->Viable &&
6601 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006602 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
6603 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
6604 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
6605 //
6606 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
6607 // different ambiguities, though.
6608 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006609 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006610 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
6611 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006612
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006613 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006614 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006615 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006616 }
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00006617
6618 if (I != E)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006619 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006620}
6621
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006622static bool CheckUnresolvedAccess(Sema &S, OverloadExpr *E, DeclAccessPair D) {
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006623 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E))
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006624 return S.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E), D);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006625
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006626 return S.CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E), D);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006627}
6628
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006629/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
6630/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
6631/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
6632/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
6633///
6634/// @code
6635/// int f(double);
6636/// int f(int);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006637///
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006638/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
6639/// @endcode
6640///
6641/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
6642/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
6643/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
6644FunctionDecl *
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006645Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006646 bool Complain,
6647 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006648 QualType FunctionType = ToType;
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006649 bool IsMember = false;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006650 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006651 FunctionType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006652 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Daniel Dunbarb566c6c2009-02-26 19:13:44 +00006653 FunctionType = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006654 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006655 ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006656 FunctionType = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
6657 IsMember = true;
6658 }
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006659
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006660 // C++ [over.over]p1:
6661 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
6662 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006663 // C++ [over.over]p1:
6664 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
6665 // operator.
John McCall7d460512010-08-24 23:26:21 +00006666 // However, remember whether the expression has member-pointer form:
6667 // C++ [expr.unary.op]p4:
6668 // A pointer to member is only formed when an explicit & is used
6669 // and its operand is a qualified-id not enclosed in
6670 // parentheses.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006671 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(From);
6672 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
John McCall7d460512010-08-24 23:26:21 +00006673
Douglas Gregor064fdb22010-04-14 23:11:21 +00006674 // We expect a pointer or reference to function, or a function pointer.
6675 FunctionType = Context.getCanonicalType(FunctionType).getUnqualifiedType();
6676 if (!FunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
6677 if (Complain)
6678 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
6679 << OvlExpr->getName() << ToType;
6680
6681 return 0;
6682 }
6683
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00006684 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
John McCall7d460512010-08-24 23:26:21 +00006685 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006686 if (IsMember && !Ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer) {
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00006687 if (!Complain) return 0;
6688
6689 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
6690 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
6691 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
6692 Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
6693 << ToType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
6694 return 0;
6695 }
6696
6697 TemplateArgumentListInfo ETABuffer, *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
6698 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
6699 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ETABuffer);
6700 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &ETABuffer;
6701 }
6702
Douglas Gregor064fdb22010-04-14 23:11:21 +00006703 assert(From->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006704
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006705 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
6706 // whose type matches exactly.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006707 llvm::SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
Douglas Gregorb242683d2010-04-01 18:32:35 +00006708 llvm::SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> NonMatches;
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006709
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006710 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction = false;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006711 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6712 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00006713 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
6714 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
6715
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006716 // C++ [over.over]p3:
6717 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
Sebastian Redl16d307d2009-02-05 12:33:33 +00006718 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
6719 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006720 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
6721 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006722
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006723 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00006724 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006725 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006726 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006727 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006728 // static when converting to member pointer.
6729 if (Method->isStatic() == IsMember)
6730 continue;
6731 } else if (IsMember)
6732 continue;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006733
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006734 // C++ [over.over]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006735 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
6736 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
6737 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
6738 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006739 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006740 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00006741 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006742 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006743 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006744 FunctionType, Specialization, Info)) {
6745 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
6746 (void)Result;
6747 } else {
Douglas Gregor4ed49f32010-09-29 21:14:36 +00006748 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
6749 // This function template specicalization works.
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006750 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006751 assert(FunctionType
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006752 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006753 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(I.getPair(), Specialization));
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006754 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006755
6756 continue;
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006757 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006758
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00006759 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006760 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
6761 // when converting to member pointer.
6762 if (Method->isStatic() == IsMember)
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006763 continue;
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00006764
6765 // If we have explicit template arguments, skip non-templates.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006766 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00006767 continue;
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006768 } else if (IsMember)
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006769 continue;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006770
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00006771 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00006772 QualType ResultTy;
6773 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FunctionType, FunDecl->getType()) ||
6774 IsNoReturnConversion(Context, FunDecl->getType(), FunctionType,
6775 ResultTy)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006776 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(I.getPair(),
6777 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006778 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
6779 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006780 }
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006781 }
6782
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006783 // If there were 0 or 1 matches, we're done.
Douglas Gregor064fdb22010-04-14 23:11:21 +00006784 if (Matches.empty()) {
6785 if (Complain) {
6786 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
6787 << OvlExpr->getName() << FunctionType;
6788 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6789 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
6790 I != E; ++I)
6791 if (FunctionDecl *F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
6792 NoteOverloadCandidate(F);
6793 }
6794
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006795 return 0;
Douglas Gregor064fdb22010-04-14 23:11:21 +00006796 } else if (Matches.size() == 1) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006797 FunctionDecl *Result = Matches[0].second;
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006798 FoundResult = Matches[0].first;
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00006799 MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Result);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006800 if (Complain) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006801 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(OvlExpr, Matches[0].first);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006802 }
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00006803 return Result;
6804 }
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006805
6806 // C++ [over.over]p4:
6807 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
Douglas Gregorfae1d712009-09-26 03:56:17 +00006808 if (!FoundNonTemplateFunction) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006809 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
6810 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
6811 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
6812 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
6813 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
6814
6815 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
6816 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
6817 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
6818 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006819
6820 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
6821 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
6822 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006823
6824 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006825 getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00006826 TPOC_Other, From->getLocStart(),
6827 PDiag(),
6828 PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006829 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006830 PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
6831 << (unsigned) oc_function_template);
Douglas Gregorbdd7b232010-09-12 08:16:09 +00006832 if (Result == MatchesCopy.end())
6833 return 0;
6834
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006835 MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), *Result);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006836 FoundResult = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006837 if (Complain)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006838 CheckUnresolvedAccess(*this, OvlExpr, FoundResult);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006839 return cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006840 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006841
Douglas Gregorfae1d712009-09-26 03:56:17 +00006842 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
6843 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006844 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006845 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006846 ++I;
6847 else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006848 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
6849 Matches.set_size(N);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006850 }
6851 }
Douglas Gregorfae1d712009-09-26 03:56:17 +00006852
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006853 // [...] After such eliminations, if any, there shall remain exactly one
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006854 // selected function.
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006855 if (Matches.size() == 1) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006856 MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Matches[0].second);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006857 FoundResult = Matches[0].first;
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006858 if (Complain)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006859 CheckUnresolvedAccess(*this, OvlExpr, Matches[0].first);
6860 return cast<FunctionDecl>(Matches[0].second);
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00006861 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006862
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006863 // FIXME: We should probably return the same thing that BestViableFunction
6864 // returns (even if we issue the diagnostics here).
Douglas Gregore81f58e2010-11-08 03:40:48 +00006865 if (Complain) {
6866 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
6867 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName();
6868 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
6869 NoteOverloadCandidate(Matches[I].second);
6870 }
6871
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006872 return 0;
6873}
6874
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006875/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
6876/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
6877///
6878/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
6879/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
6880/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
6881/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
6882FunctionDecl *Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Expr *From) {
6883 // C++ [over.over]p1:
6884 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
6885 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006886 // C++ [over.over]p1:
6887 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
6888 // operator.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006889
6890 if (From->getType() != Context.OverloadTy)
6891 return 0;
6892
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006893 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = OverloadExpr::find(From).Expression;
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006894
6895 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006896 if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006897 return 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006898
6899 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
6900 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006901
6902 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
6903 // whose type matches exactly.
6904 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006905 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6906 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006907 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
6908 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
6909 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
6910 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
6911 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
6912 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregoreebe7212010-07-14 23:20:53 +00006913 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
6914 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006915
6916 // C++ [over.over]p2:
6917 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
6918 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
6919 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
6920 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
6921 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006922 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00006923 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006924 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
6925 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
6926 Specialization, Info)) {
6927 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
6928 (void)Result;
6929 continue;
6930 }
6931
6932 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
6933 if (Matched)
6934 return 0;
6935
6936 Matched = Specialization;
6937 }
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00006938
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006939 return Matched;
6940}
6941
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006942/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
6943static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006944 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00006945 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006946 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6947 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6948 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006949 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006950 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
6951 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
6952
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006953 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00006954 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs && "Explicit template arguments?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006955 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00006956 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006957 return;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006958 }
6959
6960 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
6961 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006962 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
6963 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006964 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006965 return;
6966 }
6967
6968 assert(false && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
6969
6970 // do nothing?
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006971}
6972
6973/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
6974/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006975void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006976 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6977 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6978 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006979
6980#ifndef NDEBUG
6981 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
6982 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006983 //
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006984 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
6985 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
6986 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
6987 //
6988 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
6989 //
6990 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006991 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006992 //
6993 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
6994 // template
6995 //
6996 // then Y is empty.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006997
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006998 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
6999 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
7000 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7001 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
7002 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
7003 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
7004 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007005 }
7006 }
7007#endif
7008
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007009 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
7010 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
7011 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
7012 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7013 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
7014 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
7015 }
7016
7017 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
7018 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007019 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007020 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007021 PartialOverloading);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007022
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007023 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007024 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
7025 Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007026 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007027 CandidateSet,
7028 PartialOverloading);
7029}
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007030
7031/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
7032///
7033/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007034static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007035BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007036 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
7037 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7038 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007039 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007040
7041 CXXScopeSpec SS;
7042 if (ULE->getQualifier()) {
7043 SS.setScopeRep(ULE->getQualifier());
7044 SS.setRange(ULE->getQualifierRange());
7045 }
7046
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007047 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
7048 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
7049 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7050 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
7051 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
7052 }
7053
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007054 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
7055 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00007056 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Sema::CTC_Expression))
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007057 return ExprError();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007058
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007059 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
7060
7061 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
7062 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007063 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007064 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007065 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R,
7066 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007067 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
7068 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *ExplicitTemplateArgs);
7069 else
7070 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
7071
7072 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007073 return ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007074
7075 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
7076 // an expression with non-empty lookup results, which should never
7077 // end up here.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007078 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007079 MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007080}
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00007081
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007082/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007083/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
7084/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
7085/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
7086/// the function declaration produced by overload
Douglas Gregora60a6912008-11-26 06:01:48 +00007087/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007088/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007089ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007090Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007091 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7092 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007093 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
7094#ifndef NDEBUG
7095 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
7096 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
7097 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
7098
7099 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
7100 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
7101 FunctionDecl *F;
7102 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
7103 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
7104 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
7105 assert(0 && "performing ADL for builtin");
7106
7107 // We don't perform ADL in C.
7108 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
7109 }
7110#endif
7111
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007112 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00007113
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007114 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
7115 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
7116 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007117
7118 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
7119 // AddRecoveryCallCandidates diagnoses the error itself, so we just
7120 // bailout out if it fails.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007121 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007122 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007123 RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007124
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007125 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007126 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007127 case OR_Success: {
7128 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007129 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007130 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl? FDecl : Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(),
7131 ULE->getNameLoc());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007132 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007133 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
7134 RParenLoc);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007135 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007136
7137 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Chris Lattner45d9d602009-02-17 07:29:20 +00007138 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007139 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007140 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007141 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007142 break;
7143
7144 case OR_Ambiguous:
7145 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007146 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007147 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007148 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007149
7150 case OR_Deleted:
7151 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
7152 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007153 << ULE->getName()
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007154 << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007155 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007156 break;
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007157 }
7158
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007159 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007160 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007161}
7162
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007163static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00007164 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
7165 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
7166}
7167
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007168/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
7169/// operator.
7170///
7171/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
7172///
7173/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
7174/// operator.
7175///
7176/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
7177/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
7178/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
7179/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
7180/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
7181/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
7182///
7183/// \param input The input argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007184ExprResult
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007185Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
7186 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007187 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007188 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007189
7190 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
7191 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
7192 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007193 // TODO: provide better source location info.
7194 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007195
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00007196 if (Input->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
7197 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Input);
7198
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007199 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
7200 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007201
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007202 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
7203 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
7204 // post-decrement.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007205 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007206 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00007207 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
7208 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007209 NumArgs = 2;
7210 }
7211
7212 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007213 if (Fns.empty())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007214 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007215 Opc,
7216 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007217 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007218 OpLoc));
7219
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007220 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007221 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007222 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*Dependent*/ true, NamingClass,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007223 0, SourceRange(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00007224 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
7225 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007226 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
7227 &Args[0], NumArgs,
7228 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007229 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007230 OpLoc));
7231 }
7232
7233 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007234 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007235
7236 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007237 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007238
7239 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
7240 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
7241
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007242 // Add candidates from ADL.
7243 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Douglas Gregor6ec89d42010-02-05 05:15:43 +00007244 Args, NumArgs,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007245 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
7246 CandidateSet);
7247
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007248 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00007249 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007250
7251 // Perform overload resolution.
7252 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007253 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007254 case OR_Success: {
7255 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
7256 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007257
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007258 if (FnDecl) {
7259 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
7260 // operator.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007261
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007262 // Convert the arguments.
7263 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007264 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00007265
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007266 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
7267 Best->FoundDecl, Method))
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007268 return ExprError();
7269 } else {
7270 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007271 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00007272 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00007273 Context,
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00007274 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00007275 SourceLocation(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007276 Input);
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00007277 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007278 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007279 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007280 }
7281
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007282 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
7283
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007284 // Determine the result type.
7285 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
7286 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
7287 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007288
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007289 // Build the actual expression node.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007290 Expr *FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007291
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +00007292 Args[0] = Input;
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007293 CallExpr *TheCall =
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00007294 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007295 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007296
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007297 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00007298 FnDecl))
7299 return ExprError();
7300
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007301 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007302 } else {
7303 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
7304 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
7305 // operator node.
7306 if (PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007307 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing))
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007308 return ExprError();
7309
7310 break;
7311 }
7312 }
7313
7314 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
7315 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
7316 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
7317 break;
7318
7319 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00007320 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007321 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00007322 << Input->getType()
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007323 << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007324 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
7325 Args, NumArgs,
7326 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007327 return ExprError();
7328
7329 case OR_Deleted:
7330 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
7331 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
7332 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
7333 << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007334 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007335 return ExprError();
7336 }
7337
7338 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
7339 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
7340 // build a built-in operation.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007341 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007342}
7343
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007344/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
7345/// operator.
7346///
7347/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
7348///
7349/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
7350/// operator.
7351///
7352/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
7353/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
7354/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
7355/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
7356/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
7357/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
7358///
7359/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
7360/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007361ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007362Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007363 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007364 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007365 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007366 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007367 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007368
7369 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
7370 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
7371 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
7372
7373 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
7374 // expression.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007375 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007376 if (Fns.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007377 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
7378 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007379 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007380 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007381 Context.DependentTy,
7382 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
7383 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007384
7385 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
7386 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007387 VK_LValue,
7388 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007389 Context.DependentTy,
7390 Context.DependentTy,
7391 OpLoc));
7392 }
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007393
7394 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007395 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007396 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
7397 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007398 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007399 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*Dependent*/ true, NamingClass,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007400 0, SourceRange(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00007401 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
7402 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007403 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007404 Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007405 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007406 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007407 OpLoc));
7408 }
7409
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00007410 // Always do property rvalue conversions on the RHS.
7411 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
7412 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
7413
7414 // The LHS is more complicated.
7415 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
7416
7417 // There's a tension for assignment operators between primitive
7418 // property assignment and the overloaded operators.
7419 if (BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) {
7420 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = LHS->getObjCProperty();
7421
7422 // Is the property "logically" settable?
7423 bool Settable = (PRE->isExplicitProperty() ||
7424 PRE->getImplicitPropertySetter());
7425
7426 // To avoid gratuitously inventing semantics, use the primitive
7427 // unless it isn't. Thoughts in case we ever really care:
7428 // - If the property isn't logically settable, we have to
7429 // load and hope.
7430 // - If the property is settable and this is simple assignment,
7431 // we really should use the primitive.
7432 // - If the property is settable, then we could try overloading
7433 // on a generic lvalue of the appropriate type; if it works
7434 // out to a builtin candidate, we would do that same operation
7435 // on the property, and otherwise just error.
7436 if (Settable)
7437 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
7438 }
7439
7440 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
7441 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007442
Sebastian Redl6a96bf72009-11-18 23:10:33 +00007443 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
7444 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
7445 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
7446 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
7447 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
7448 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007449 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007450 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007451
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00007452 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
7453 // create a built-in binary operator.
7454 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
7455 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
7456
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007457 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007458 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007459
7460 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007461 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, 2, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007462
7463 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
7464 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7465
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007466 // Add candidates from ADL.
7467 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
7468 Args, 2,
7469 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
7470 CandidateSet);
7471
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007472 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00007473 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007474
7475 // Perform overload resolution.
7476 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007477 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00007478 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007479 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
7480 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
7481
7482 if (FnDecl) {
7483 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
7484 // operator.
7485
7486 // Convert the arguments.
7487 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00007488 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007489 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00007490
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007491 ExprResult Arg1 =
7492 PerformCopyInitialization(
7493 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
7494 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
7495 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00007496 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007497 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00007498
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007499 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007500 Best->FoundDecl, Method))
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00007501 return ExprError();
7502
7503 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007504 } else {
7505 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007506 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
7507 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
7508 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
7509 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00007510 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007511 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00007512
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007513 ExprResult Arg1 =
7514 PerformCopyInitialization(
7515 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
7516 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
7517 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00007518 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
7519 return ExprError();
7520 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
7521 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007522 }
7523
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007524 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
7525
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007526 // Determine the result type.
7527 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
7528 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
7529 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007530
7531 // Build the actual expression node.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007532 Expr *FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007533
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007534 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
7535 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007536 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00007537
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007538 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00007539 FnDecl))
7540 return ExprError();
7541
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007542 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007543 } else {
7544 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
7545 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
7546 // operator node.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007547 if (PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007548 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing) ||
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007549 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007550 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing))
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007551 return ExprError();
7552
7553 break;
7554 }
7555 }
7556
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007557 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
7558 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
7559 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
7560 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
7561 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007562 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007563 break;
7564
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007565 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
7566 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
7567 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007568 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007569 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007570 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00007571 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
7572 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007573 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007574 } else {
7575 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
7576 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
7577 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00007578 }
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007579 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
7580 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
7581 if (Result.isInvalid())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007582 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
7583 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007584 return move(Result);
7585 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007586
7587 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00007588 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007589 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00007590 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007591 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007592 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
7593 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007594 return ExprError();
7595
7596 case OR_Deleted:
7597 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
7598 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
7599 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007600 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007601 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007602 return ExprError();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007603 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007604
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00007605 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00007606 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007607}
7608
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007609ExprResult
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007610Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
7611 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007612 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
7613 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007614 DeclarationName OpName =
7615 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
7616
7617 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
7618 // expression.
7619 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
7620
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007621 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007622 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
7623 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
7624 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007625 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007626 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*Dependent*/ true, NamingClass,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007627 0, SourceRange(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00007628 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
7629 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
7630 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00007631 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007632
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007633 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
7634 Args, 2,
7635 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007636 VK_RValue,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007637 RLoc));
7638 }
7639
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00007640 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
7641 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
7642 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
7643 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
7644
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007645 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007646 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007647
7648 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
7649
7650 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
7651 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7652
7653 // Add builtin operator candidates.
7654 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
7655
7656 // Perform overload resolution.
7657 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007658 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007659 case OR_Success: {
7660 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
7661 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
7662
7663 if (FnDecl) {
7664 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
7665 // operator.
7666
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007667 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007668 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007669
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007670 // Convert the arguments.
7671 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007672 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007673 Best->FoundDecl, Method))
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007674 return ExprError();
7675
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00007676 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007677 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00007678 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00007679 Context,
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00007680 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
7681 SourceLocation(),
7682 Owned(Args[1]));
7683 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
7684 return ExprError();
7685
7686 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
7687
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007688 // Determine the result type
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007689 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
7690 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
7691 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007692
7693 // Build the actual expression node.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007694 Expr *FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007695
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007696 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
7697 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
7698 FnExpr, Args, 2,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007699 ResultTy, VK, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007700
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007701 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007702 FnDecl))
7703 return ExprError();
7704
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007705 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007706 } else {
7707 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
7708 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
7709 // operator node.
7710 if (PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007711 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing) ||
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007712 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007713 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing))
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007714 return ExprError();
7715
7716 break;
7717 }
7718 }
7719
7720 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00007721 if (CandidateSet.empty())
7722 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
7723 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
7724 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
7725 else
7726 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
7727 << Args[0]->getType()
7728 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007729 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
7730 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00007731 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007732 }
7733
7734 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00007735 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
7736 << "[]"
7737 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
7738 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007739 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
7740 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007741 return ExprError();
7742
7743 case OR_Deleted:
7744 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
7745 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
7746 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007747 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
7748 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007749 return ExprError();
7750 }
7751
7752 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007753 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007754}
7755
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007756/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
7757/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
7758/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
7759/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
7760/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
7761/// expression refers to a member function or an overloaded member
7762/// function.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007763ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007764Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
7765 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007766 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007767 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
7768 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007769 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
7770
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007771 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007772 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCall3a65ef42010-04-08 00:13:37 +00007773 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007774 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007775 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
7776 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007777 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007778 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007779 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007780 } else {
7781 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007782 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
7783
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007784 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007785
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007786 // Add overload candidates
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007787 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007788
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007789 // FIXME: avoid copy.
7790 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
7791 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7792 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
7793 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
7794 }
7795
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007796 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
7797 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7798
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007799 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
7800 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
7801 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
7802 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
7803
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007804 if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00007805 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
7806 // non-template member function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007807 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00007808 continue;
7809
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007810 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00007811 Args, NumArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007812 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007813 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007814 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007815 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007816 ObjectType, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00007817 CandidateSet,
7818 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007819 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00007820 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007821
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007822 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
7823
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007824 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007825 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007826 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007827 case OR_Success:
7828 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007829 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007830 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007831 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007832 break;
7833
7834 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007835 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007836 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00007837 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007838 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007839 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007840 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007841
7842 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007843 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00007844 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007845 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007846 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007847 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007848
7849 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007850 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007851 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00007852 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007853 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007854 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007855 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007856 }
7857
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007858 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007859
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007860 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
7861 // non-member call based on that function.
7862 if (Method->isStatic()) {
7863 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
7864 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
7865 }
7866
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007867 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007868 }
7869
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007870 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
7871 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
7872 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7873
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007874 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007875 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
7876 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007877 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007878
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +00007879 // Check for a valid return type.
7880 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007881 TheCall, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007882 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +00007883
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007884 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007885 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
7886 // it was done at lookup.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007887 Expr *ObjectArg = MemExpr->getBase();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007888 if (!Method->isStatic() &&
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007889 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(ObjectArg, Qualifier,
7890 FoundDecl, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007891 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007892 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg);
7893
7894 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007895 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
7896 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007897 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007898 RParenLoc))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007899 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007900
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007901 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007902 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8c84c202009-08-16 03:42:12 +00007903
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007904 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007905}
7906
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007907/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
7908/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
7909/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
7910/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007911ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007912Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Object,
Douglas Gregorb0846b02008-12-06 00:22:45 +00007913 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007914 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007915 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00007916 if (Object->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
7917 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Object);
7918
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007919 assert(Object->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007920 const RecordType *Record = Object->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007921
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007922 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
7923 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman44b83ee2009-08-05 19:21:58 +00007924 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007925 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
7926 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
7927 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
7928 // (E).operator().
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007929 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00007930 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00007931
7932 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007933 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call)
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00007934 << Object->getSourceRange()))
7935 return true;
7936
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00007937 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
7938 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
7939 R.suppressDiagnostics();
7940
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00007941 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00007942 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007943 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object->getType(),
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00007944 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00007945 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00007946 }
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00007947
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007948 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
7949 // In addition, for each conversion function declared in T of the
7950 // form
7951 //
7952 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
7953 //
7954 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
7955 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregorf49fdf82008-11-20 13:33:37 +00007956 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
7957 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
7958 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
7959 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007960 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
7961 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
7962 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
7963 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
7964 // within T by another intervening declaration.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00007965 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Douglas Gregor21591822010-01-11 19:36:35 +00007966 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00007967 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007968 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007969 NamedDecl *D = *I;
7970 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
7971 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
7972 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
7973
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00007974 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
7975 // surrogates.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007976 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00007977 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007978
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007979 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007980
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00007981 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
7982 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
7983 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7984 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
7985 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007986
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00007987 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007988 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007989 Object->getType(), Args, NumArgs,
7990 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007991 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007992
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007993 // Perform overload resolution.
7994 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007995 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object->getLocStart(),
7996 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007997 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007998 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
7999 // below.
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008000 break;
8001
8002 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008003 if (CandidateSet.empty())
8004 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
8005 << Object->getType() << /*call*/ 1
8006 << Object->getSourceRange();
8007 else
8008 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
8009 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
8010 << Object->getType() << Object->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008011 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008012 break;
8013
8014 case OR_Ambiguous:
8015 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
8016 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00008017 << Object->getType() << Object->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008018 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008019 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008020
8021 case OR_Deleted:
8022 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
8023 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
8024 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8025 << Object->getType() << Object->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008026 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008027 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008028 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008029
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008030 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008031 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008032
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008033 if (Best->Function == 0) {
8034 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
8035 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008036 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008037 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
8038 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
8039
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008040 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008041 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00008042
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008043 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
8044 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
8045 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +00008046
8047 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +00008048 // and then call it.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008049 CXXMemberCallExpr *CE = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object, Best->FoundDecl,
8050 Conv);
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +00008051
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00008052 return ActOnCallExpr(S, CE, LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00008053 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008054 }
8055
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008056 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008057 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00008058
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008059 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
8060 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
8061 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
8062 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008063 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
8064 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008065
8066 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8067 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
8068
8069 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
8070 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
8071 // list).
8072 Expr **MethodArgs;
8073 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
8074 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
8075 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
8076 } else {
8077 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
8078 }
8079 MethodArgs[0] = Object;
8080 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
8081 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008082
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008083 Expr *NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008084
8085 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
8086 // owned.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008087 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
8088 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8089 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8090
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008091 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
8092 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn,
8093 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008094 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008095 delete [] MethodArgs;
8096
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008097 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson3d5829c2009-10-13 21:49:31 +00008098 Method))
8099 return true;
8100
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008101 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
8102 // slots in the call for them.
8103 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00008104 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008105 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
8106 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
8107
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008108 bool IsError = false;
8109
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008110 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008111 IsError |= PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object, /*Qualifier=*/0,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008112 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008113 TheCall->setArg(0, Object);
8114
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008115
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008116 // Check the argument types.
8117 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008118 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008119 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008120 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008121
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008122 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008123
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008124 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008125 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00008126 Context,
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008127 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008128 SourceLocation(), Arg);
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008129
8130 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
8131 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008132 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008133 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00008134 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
8135 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
8136 IsError = true;
8137 break;
8138 }
8139
8140 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008141 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008142
8143 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
8144 }
8145
8146 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
8147 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
8148 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
8149 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) {
8150 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00008151 IsError |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, VariadicMethod, 0);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008152 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
8153 }
8154 }
8155
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008156 if (IsError) return true;
8157
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008158 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00008159 return true;
8160
John McCalle172be52010-08-24 06:09:16 +00008161 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008162}
8163
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008164/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008165/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008166/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008167ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008168Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008169 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
8170 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008171
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008172 if (Base->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty)
8173 ConvertPropertyForRValue(Base);
8174
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008175 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
8176
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008177 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
8178 //
8179 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
8180 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
8181 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
8182 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008183 DeclarationName OpName =
8184 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008185 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008186 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008187
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008188 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Eli Friedman132e70b2009-11-18 01:28:03 +00008189 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
8190 << Base->getSourceRange()))
8191 return ExprError();
8192
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00008193 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
8194 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
8195 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +00008196
8197 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008198 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008199 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), 0, 0, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008200 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008201 }
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008202
8203 // Perform overload resolution.
8204 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008205 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008206 case OR_Success:
8207 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
8208 break;
8209
8210 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
8211 if (CandidateSet.empty())
8212 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008213 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008214 else
8215 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008216 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008217 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008218 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008219
8220 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008221 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
8222 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008223 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008224 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008225
8226 case OR_Deleted:
8227 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8228 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +00008229 << "->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008230 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008231 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008232 }
8233
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008234 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008235 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008236
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008237 // Convert the object parameter.
8238 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008239 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
8240 Best->FoundDecl, Method))
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008241 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ecea262008-11-21 03:04:22 +00008242
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008243 // Build the operator call.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008244 Expr *FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00008245
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008246 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
8247 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8248 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008249 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
8250 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008251 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00008252
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008253 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00008254 Method))
8255 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008256 return Owned(TheCall);
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008257}
8258
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008259/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
8260/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
8261/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
8262/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +00008263/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00008264Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008265 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008266 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008267 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
8268 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008269 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00008270 return PE;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008271
8272 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
8273 }
8274
8275 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008276 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
8277 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +00008278 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008279 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +00008280 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00008281 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008282 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00008283 return ICE;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008284
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00008285 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
8286 ICE->getCastKind(),
8287 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00008288 ICE->getValueKind());
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008289 }
8290
8291 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008292 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008293 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00008294 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8295 if (Method->isStatic()) {
8296 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
8297 // from non-member functions.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008298 } else {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00008299 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
8300 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
8301 // or template.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008302 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
8303 Found, Fn);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008304 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00008305 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008306
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008307 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
8308 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
8309 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
8310 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
8311
8312 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
8313 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
8314 // appropriate pointer to member type.
8315 QualType ClassType
8316 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
8317 QualType MemPtrType
8318 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
8319
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008320 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
8321 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
8322 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00008323 }
8324 }
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008325 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
8326 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008327 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00008328 return UnOp;
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +00008329
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008330 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008331 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008332 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008333 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008334 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008335
8336 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008337 // FIXME: avoid copy.
8338 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00008339 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008340 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
8341 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00008342 }
8343
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008344 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
8345 ULE->getQualifier(),
8346 ULE->getQualifierRange(),
8347 Fn,
8348 ULE->getNameLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008349 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008350 VK_LValue,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008351 TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008352 }
8353
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008354 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008355 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008356 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
8357 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8358 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
8359 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
8360 }
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008361
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008362 Expr *Base;
8363
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008364 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
8365 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008366 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
8367 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
8368 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
8369 MemExpr->getQualifier(),
8370 MemExpr->getQualifierRange(),
8371 Fn,
8372 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
8373 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008374 VK_LValue,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008375 TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00008376 } else {
8377 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
8378 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
8379 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierRange().getBegin();
8380 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
8381 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
8382 /*isImplicit=*/true);
8383 }
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008384 } else
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00008385 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008386
8387 return MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008388 MemExpr->isArrow(),
8389 MemExpr->getQualifier(),
8390 MemExpr->getQualifierRange(),
8391 Fn,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008392 Found,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008393 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008394 TemplateArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008395 Fn->getType(),
8396 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()
8397 ? VK_LValue : VK_RValue,
8398 OK_Ordinary);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00008399 }
8400
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00008401 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
8402 return E;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00008403}
8404
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008405ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
8406 DeclAccessPair Found,
8407 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008408 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +00008409}
8410
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008411} // end namespace clang